blob: 6335cc1fcb7e457cbbcb976127b33c2748445cf3 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "Sema.h"
John McCall5cebab12009-11-18 07:57:50 +000015#include "Lookup.h"
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000016#include "SemaInit.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000017#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000018#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000020#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000022#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000023#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000024#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000025#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000026#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000027#include <algorithm>
28
29namespace clang {
30
31/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
32/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000033ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000034GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
35 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
36 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
37 ICC_Identity,
38 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
39 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
40 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000041 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000042 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
43 ICC_Promotion,
44 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000045 ICC_Promotion,
46 ICC_Conversion,
47 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000048 ICC_Conversion,
49 ICC_Conversion,
50 ICC_Conversion,
51 ICC_Conversion,
52 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +000053 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +000054 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +000055 ICC_Conversion,
56 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000057 ICC_Conversion
58 };
59 return Category[(int)Kind];
60}
61
62/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
63/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
64ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
65 static const ImplicitConversionRank
66 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
67 ICR_Exact_Match,
68 ICR_Exact_Match,
69 ICR_Exact_Match,
70 ICR_Exact_Match,
71 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000072 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000073 ICR_Promotion,
74 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000075 ICR_Promotion,
76 ICR_Conversion,
77 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000078 ICR_Conversion,
79 ICR_Conversion,
80 ICR_Conversion,
81 ICR_Conversion,
82 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +000083 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +000084 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +000085 ICR_Conversion,
86 ICR_Conversion,
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +000087 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000088 };
89 return Rank[(int)Kind];
90}
91
92/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
93/// implicit conversion.
94const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +000095 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000096 "No conversion",
97 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
98 "Array-to-pointer",
99 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000100 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000101 "Qualification",
102 "Integral promotion",
103 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000104 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000105 "Integral conversion",
106 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000107 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000108 "Floating-integral conversion",
109 "Pointer conversion",
110 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000111 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000112 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000113 "Derived-to-base conversion",
114 "Vector conversion",
115 "Vector splat",
116 "Complex-real conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000117 };
118 return Name[Kind];
119}
120
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000121/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
122/// sequence to the identity conversion.
123void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
124 First = ICK_Identity;
125 Second = ICK_Identity;
126 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000127 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000128 ReferenceBinding = false;
129 DirectBinding = false;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +0000130 RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000131 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000132}
133
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000134/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
135/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
136/// implicit conversions.
137ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
138 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
139 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
140 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
141 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
142 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
143 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
144 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
145 return Rank;
146}
147
148/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
149/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000150/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000151/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000153 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
154 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
155 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
156 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000157 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000158 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
159 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
160 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000161 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
162 return true;
163
164 return false;
165}
166
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000167/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
168/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
169/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
170/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000171bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000172StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000173isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000174 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000175 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000176
177 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
178 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
179 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
180 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
181 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
182
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +0000183 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000184 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000185 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
186
187 return false;
188}
189
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000190/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
191/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
192void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000193 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000194 bool PrintedSomething = false;
195 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000196 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000197 PrintedSomething = true;
198 }
199
200 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
201 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000202 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000203 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000204 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000205
206 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000207 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000208 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000209 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000210 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000211 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000212 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000213 PrintedSomething = true;
214 }
215
216 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
217 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000218 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000219 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000220 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221 PrintedSomething = true;
222 }
223
224 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000225 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000226 }
227}
228
229/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
230/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
231void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000232 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000233 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
234 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000235 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000236 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000237 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000239 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000240 After.DebugPrint();
241 }
242}
243
244/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
245/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
246void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000247 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000248 switch (ConversionKind) {
249 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000250 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000251 Standard.DebugPrint();
252 break;
253 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000254 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000255 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
256 break;
257 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000258 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000259 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000260 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000261 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000262 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000265 break;
266 }
267
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000268 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000269}
270
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000271void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
272 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
273}
274
275void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
276 conversions().~ConversionSet();
277}
278
279void
280AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
281 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
282 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
283 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
284}
285
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000286namespace {
287 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
288 // template parameter and template argument information.
289 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
290 TemplateParameter Param;
291 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
292 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
293 };
294}
295
296/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
297/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
298OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000299static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
300 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000301 Sema::TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000302 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
303 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
304 Result.Data = 0;
305 switch (TDK) {
306 case Sema::TDK_Success:
307 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000308 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
309 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000310 break;
311
312 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000313 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000314 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
315 break;
316
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000317 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
318 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000319 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
320 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000321 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
322 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
323 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
324 Result.Data = Saved;
325 break;
326 }
327
328 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000329 Result.Data = Info.take();
330 break;
331
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000332 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000333 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
334 break;
335 }
336
337 return Result;
338}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000339
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000340void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
341 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
342 case Sema::TDK_Success:
343 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
344 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000345 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
346 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000347 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000348 break;
349
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000350 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
351 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000352 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000353 Data = 0;
354 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000355
356 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
357 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
358 Data = 0;
359 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000360
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000361 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000362 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000363 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
364 break;
365 }
366}
367
368TemplateParameter
369OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
370 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
371 case Sema::TDK_Success:
372 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000373 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
374 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000375 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000376 return TemplateParameter();
377
378 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000379 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000380 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
381
382 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
383 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals:
384 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
385
386 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000387 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000388 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
389 break;
390 }
391
392 return TemplateParameter();
393}
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000394
395TemplateArgumentList *
396OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
397 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
398 case Sema::TDK_Success:
399 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
400 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
401 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
402 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
403 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
404 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
405 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals:
406 return 0;
407
408 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
409 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
410
411 // Unhandled
412 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
413 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
414 break;
415 }
416
417 return 0;
418}
419
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000420const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
421 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
422 case Sema::TDK_Success:
423 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
424 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000425 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
426 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000427 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000428 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000429 return 0;
430
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000431 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
432 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals:
433 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
434
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000435 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000436 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000437 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
438 break;
439 }
440
441 return 0;
442}
443
444const TemplateArgument *
445OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
446 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
447 case Sema::TDK_Success:
448 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
449 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000450 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
451 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000452 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000453 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000454 return 0;
455
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000456 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
457 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals:
458 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
459
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000460 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000461 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000462 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
463 break;
464 }
465
466 return 0;
467}
468
469void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000470 inherited::clear();
471 Functions.clear();
472}
473
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000474// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000475// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
476// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
477// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
478// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000479// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
480// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
481// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000482//
483// Example: Given the following input:
484//
485// void f(int, float); // #1
486// void f(int, int); // #2
487// int f(int, int); // #3
488//
489// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000490// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000491//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000492// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
493// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
494// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
495// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000496//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000497// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
498// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
499// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
500// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000501// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
502// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000503//
504// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
505// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
506// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
507// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000508Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000509Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
510 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000511 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000512 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000513 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
514
515 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
516 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
517 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
518
519 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
520 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
521 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
522
523 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
524 }
525
526 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
527 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
528 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
529 // function templates hide function templates with different
530 // return types or template parameter lists.
531 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
532 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
533
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000534 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000535 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
536 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
537 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
538 continue;
539 }
540
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000541 Match = *I;
542 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000543 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000544 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000545 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
546 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
547 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
548 continue;
549 }
550
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000551 Match = *I;
552 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000553 }
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000554 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
555 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
556 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
557 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
558 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
559 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
560 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
561 // template instantiation.
562 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000563 // (C++ 13p1):
564 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
565 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000566 Match = *I;
567 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000568 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000569 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000570
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000571 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000572}
573
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000574bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
575 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000576 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
577 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
578
579 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
580 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
581 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
582 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
583 return true;
584
585 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
586 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
587 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
588
589 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
590 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
591 // in the signature, they are overloads.
592
593 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
594 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
595 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
596 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
597 return false;
598
599 FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
600 FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
601
602 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
603 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
604 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
605 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
606 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
607 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000608 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000609 return true;
610
611 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
612 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
613 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
614 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
615 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
616 // signature.
617 //
618 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
619 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000620 //
621 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
622 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
623 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000624 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
625 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
626 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
627 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
628 return true;
629
630 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
631 // cv-qualifiers (if any) on the function itself.
632 //
633 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
634 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
635 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
636 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
637 // can be overloaded.
638 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
639 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
640 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
641 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
642 OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers())
643 return true;
644
645 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
646 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000647}
648
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000649/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
650/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
651/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
652/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000653///
654/// void f(float f);
655/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
656///
657/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
658/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
659/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
660/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
661//
662/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
663/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
664/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
665/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
666/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000667///
668/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
669/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000670/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
671/// permitted.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000672ImplicitConversionSequence
Anders Carlsson5ec4abf2009-08-27 17:14:02 +0000673Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr* From, QualType ToType,
674 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +0000675 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000676 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000677 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000678 if (IsStandardConversion(From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, ICS.Standard)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000679 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000680 return ICS;
681 }
682
683 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000684 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000685 return ICS;
686 }
687
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000688 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
689 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
690 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
691 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
692 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
693 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
694 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
695 // called for those cases.
696 QualType FromType = From->getType();
697 if (!ToType->getAs<RecordType>() || !FromType->getAs<RecordType>() ||
698 !(Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
699 IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
700 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
701 // we can perform.
702 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
703 return ICS;
704 }
705
706 ICS.setStandard();
707 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
708 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
709 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
710
711 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
712 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
713 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
714 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
715 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
716
717 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
718 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
719 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
720
721 return ICS;
722 }
723
724 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000725 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
726 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
727 = IsUserDefinedConversion(From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000728 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000729
730 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000731 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000732 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
733 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
734 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
735 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
736 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
737 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
738 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000739 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000740 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000741 QualType FromCanon
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000742 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
743 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000744 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
Douglas Gregor4141d5b2009-12-22 00:21:20 +0000745 (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000746 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
747 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000748 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000749 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000750 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000751 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000752 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000753 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000754 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
755 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000756 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000757
758 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
759 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
760 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
761 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
762 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
763 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
764 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000765 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000766 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000767 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000768 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000769 ICS.setAmbiguous();
770 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
771 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
772 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
773 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
774 if (Cand->Viable)
775 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000776 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000777 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000778 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000779
780 return ICS;
781}
782
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000783/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
784/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns true if there was an
785/// error, false otherwise. The expression From is replaced with the
786/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
787/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
788/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
789bool
790Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
791 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
792 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
793 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
794}
795
796bool
797Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *&From, QualType ToType,
798 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
799 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
800 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(From, ToType,
801 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
802 AllowExplicit,
803 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
804 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
805}
806
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000807/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
808/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
809static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
810 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
811 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
812 return false;
813
814 // Strip the noreturn off the type we're converting from; noreturn can
815 // safely be removed.
816 FromType = Context.getNoReturnType(FromType, false);
817 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
818 return false;
819
820 ResultTy = FromType;
821 return true;
822}
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000823
824/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
825/// vector conversion.
826///
827/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
828/// conversion.
829static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
830 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
831 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
832 // conversion.
833 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
834 return false;
835
836 // Identical types require no conversions.
837 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
838 return false;
839
840 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
841 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
842 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
843 // identity conversion.
844 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
845 return false;
846
847 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000848 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000849 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
850 return true;
851 }
852 }
853
854 // If lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
855 // same size, we can perform the conversion.
856 if (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
857 FromType->isVectorType() && ToType->isVectorType() &&
858 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)) {
859 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
860 return true;
861 }
862
863 return false;
864}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000865
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000866/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
867/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
868/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
869/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
870/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
871/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
872/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
873/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000874bool
875Sema::IsStandardConversion(Expr* From, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +0000876 bool InOverloadResolution,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000877 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000878 QualType FromType = From->getType();
879
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000880 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000881 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000882 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +0000883 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000884 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000885 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000886
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000887 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000888 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000889 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
890 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
891 return false;
892
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000893 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000894 }
895
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000896 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
897 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
898 // (C++ 4p1).
899
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +0000900 if (FromType == Context.OverloadTy) {
901 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
902 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
903 = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
904 AccessPair)) {
905 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
906 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
907 FromType = Fn->getType();
908 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
909 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
910 Type *ClassType
911 = Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
912 FromType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
913 }
914 }
915
916 // If the "from" expression takes the address of the overloaded
917 // function, update the type of the resulting expression accordingly.
918 if (FromType->getAs<FunctionType>())
919 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()))
920 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::AddrOf)
921 FromType = Context.getPointerType(FromType);
922
923 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
924 assert(Context.hasSameType(FromType,
925 FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
926 } else {
927 return false;
928 }
929 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000930 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000931 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
932 // converted to an rvalue.
933 Expr::isLvalueResult argIsLvalue = From->isLvalue(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000934 if (argIsLvalue == Expr::LV_Valid &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +0000935 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +0000936 Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000937 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000938
939 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
940 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000941 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
942 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000943 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000944 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
945 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000946 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000947
948 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
949 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
950 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
951 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
952
953 if (IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
954 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000955 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000956
957 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
958 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
959 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
960 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000961 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
962 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000963 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000964 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000965 }
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000966 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLvalue == Expr::LV_Valid) {
967 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000968 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000969
970 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
971 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
972 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
973 FromType = Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000974 } else {
975 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000976 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000977 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000978 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000979
980 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
981 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
982 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
983 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000984 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
985 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +0000986 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000987 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000988 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000989 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
990 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000991 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000992 } else if (IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000993 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000994 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000995 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000996 } else if (IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
997 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000998 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000999 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001000 } else if (IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1001 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001002 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1003 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001004 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001005 ToType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001006 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001007 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001008 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001009 } else if (FromType->isComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
1010 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001011 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1012 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001013 } else if ((FromType->isComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1014 (ToType->isComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1015 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1016 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1017 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001018 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001019 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1020 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1021 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001022 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001023 ToType->isIntegralType(Context) && !ToType->isBooleanType()) ||
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001024 (FromType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001025 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001026 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001027 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001029 } else if (IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1030 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001031 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001032 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001033 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001034 } else if (IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1035 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001036 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001037 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001038 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1039 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1040 FromType->isEnumeralType() ||
Fariborz Jahanian88118852009-12-11 21:23:13 +00001041 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001042 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1043 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001044 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001045 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001046 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001047 FromType = Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001048 } else if (IsVectorConversion(Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1049 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1050 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001051 } else if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001052 Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1053 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001054 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001055 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001056 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1057 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1058 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001059 } else {
1060 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001061 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001062 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001063 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001064
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001065 QualType CanonFrom;
1066 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001067 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001068 if (IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001069 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001070 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001071 CanonFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1072 CanonTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001073 } else {
1074 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001075 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1076
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001077 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001078 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1079 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1080 // a conversion. [...]
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001081 CanonFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001082 CanonTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001083 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1084 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001085 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1086 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001087 FromType = ToType;
1088 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1089 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001090 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001091 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001092
1093 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1094 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001095 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001096 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001097
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001098 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001099}
1100
1101/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1102/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1103/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1104/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001105bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001106 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001107 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001108 if (!To) {
1109 return false;
1110 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001111
1112 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1113 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1114 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1115 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1116 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001117 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1118 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001119 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1120 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1121 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1122 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001123 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001124 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001125 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001126 }
1127
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001128 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1129 }
1130
1131 // An rvalue of type wchar_t (3.9.1) or an enumeration type (7.2)
1132 // can be converted to an rvalue of the first of the following types
1133 // that can represent all the values of its underlying type: int,
1134 // unsigned int, long, or unsigned long (C++ 4.5p2).
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001135
1136 // We pre-calculate the promotion type for enum types.
1137 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>())
1138 if (ToType->isIntegerType())
1139 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1140 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
1141
1142 if (FromType->isWideCharType() && ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001143 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1144 // unsigned.
1145 bool FromIsSigned;
1146 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001147
1148 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1149 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001150
1151 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1152 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001153 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1154 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001155 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1156 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001157 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001158 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001159 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1160 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001161 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001162 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1163 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1164 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1165 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001166 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001167 }
1168 }
1169 }
1170
1171 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1172 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1173 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1174 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1175 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1176 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1177 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001178 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1179 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001180 using llvm::APSInt;
1181 if (From)
1182 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001183 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001184 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001185 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1186 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1187 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001188
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001189 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1190 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1191 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1192 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1193 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001194
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001195 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1196 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1197 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1198 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1199 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001200
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001201 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001202 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001203 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001204
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001205 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1206 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001207 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001208 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001209 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001210
1211 return false;
1212}
1213
1214/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1215/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1216/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001217bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001218 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1219 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1221 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001222 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1223 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1224 return true;
1225
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001226 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1227 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1228 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1229 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1230 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1231 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1232 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1233 return true;
1234 }
1235
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001236 return false;
1237}
1238
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001239/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1240///
1241/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1242/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001243/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001244bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001245 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001246 if (!FromComplex)
1247 return false;
1248
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001249 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001250 if (!ToComplex)
1251 return false;
1252
1253 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001254 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1255 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1256 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001257}
1258
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001259/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1260/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1261/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1262/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1263/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001264static QualType
1265BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const PointerType *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001266 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1267 ASTContext &Context) {
1268 QualType CanonFromPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
1269 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001270 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001271
1272 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001273 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001274 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001275 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001276 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001277
1278 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1279 // already.
1280 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1281 }
1282
1283 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001284 return Context.getPointerType(
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001285 Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(),
1286 Quals));
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001287}
1288
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001289/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedObjCObjectPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1290/// the FromType, which is an objective-c pointer, to ToType, which may or may
1291/// not have the right set of qualifiers.
1292static QualType
1293BuildSimilarlyQualifiedObjCObjectPointerType(QualType FromType,
1294 QualType ToType,
1295 ASTContext &Context) {
1296 QualType CanonFromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1297 QualType CanonToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1298 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromType.getQualifiers();
1299
1300 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
1301 if (CanonToType.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals)
1302 return ToType;
1303
1304 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
1305 return Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToType.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
1306}
1307
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001308static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001309 bool InOverloadResolution,
1310 ASTContext &Context) {
1311 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1312 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1313 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001314 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001315 return !InOverloadResolution;
1316
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001317 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1318 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1319 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001320}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001321
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001322/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1323/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1324/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1325/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1326/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1327/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001328///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001329/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1330/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1331/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1332/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1333/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1334/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001335/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1336/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1337/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001338bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001339 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001340 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001341 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001342 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001343 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC))
1344 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001345
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001346 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1347 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001348 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001349 ConvertedType = ToType;
1350 return true;
1351 }
1352
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001353 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1354 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001355 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001356 ConvertedType = ToType;
1357 return true;
1358 }
1359 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1360 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001361 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001362 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001363 ConvertedType = ToType;
1364 return true;
1365 }
1366
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001367 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1368 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001369 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001370 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001371 ConvertedType = ToType;
1372 return true;
1373 }
1374
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001375 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001376 if (!ToTypePtr)
1377 return false;
1378
1379 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001380 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001381 ConvertedType = ToType;
1382 return true;
1383 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001384
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001385 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
1386 // , including objective-c pointers.
1387 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1388 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1389 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedObjCObjectPointerType(FromType,
1390 ToType, Context);
1391 return true;
1392
1393 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001394 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001395 if (!FromTypePtr)
1396 return false;
1397
1398 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001399
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001400 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1401 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1402 // 4.10p2).
Douglas Gregor64259f52009-03-24 20:32:41 +00001403 if (FromPointeeType->isObjectType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001404 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001405 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001406 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001407 return true;
1408 }
1409
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001410 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1411 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001412 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001413 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001414 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001415 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001416 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001417 return true;
1418 }
1419
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001420 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001421 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001422 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1423 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1424 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1425 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1426 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1427 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1428 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1429 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1430 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001431 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1432 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001433 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1434 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001435 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001436 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001437 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001438 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001439 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001440 ToType, Context);
1441 return true;
1442 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001443
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001444 return false;
1445}
1446
1447/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1448/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1449/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001450bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001451 QualType& ConvertedType,
1452 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1453 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1454 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001455
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001456 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001457 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr = ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001458 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001459 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001460
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001461 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001462 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001463 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001464 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001465 ConvertedType = ToType;
1466 return true;
1467 }
1468 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001469 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001470 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001471 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001472 /*compare=*/false)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001473 ConvertedType = ToType;
1474 return true;
1475 }
1476 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1477 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1478 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001479 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1480 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1481 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1482 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1483 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1484 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001485 ConvertedType = ToType;
1486 return true;
1487 }
1488
1489 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1490 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1491 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1492 // complain about it.
1493 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1494 ConvertedType = FromType;
1495 return true;
1496 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001498 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001499 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001500 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001501 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001502 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1503 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001504 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001505 // to a block pointer type.
1506 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1507 ConvertedType = ToType;
1508 return true;
1509 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001510 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001511 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001512 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
1513 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1514 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001515 // pointer to any object.
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001516 ConvertedType = ToType;
1517 return true;
1518 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001519 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001520 return false;
1521
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001522 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001523 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001524 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001525 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr = FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001526 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1527 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001528 return false;
1529
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001530 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1531 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1532 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1533 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1534 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1535 // We always complain about this conversion.
1536 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1537 ConvertedType = ToType;
1538 return true;
1539 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001540 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1541 // as in I* to id.
1542 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1543 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1544 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1545 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1546 ConvertedType = ToType;
1547 return true;
1548 }
1549
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001550 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001551 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1552 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1553 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001554 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001555 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001556 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001557 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001558 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1559 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1560 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1561 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1562 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1563 return false;
1564
1565 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1566 // function types are obviously different.
1567 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1568 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1569 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1570 return false;
1571
1572 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1573 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1574 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1575 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1576 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1577 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1578 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1579 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1580 HasObjCConversion = true;
1581 } else {
1582 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1583 return false;
1584 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001585
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001586 // Check argument types.
1587 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1588 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1589 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1590 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1591 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1592 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1593 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1594 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1595 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1596 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1597 HasObjCConversion = true;
1598 } else {
1599 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1600 return false;
1601 }
1602 }
1603
1604 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1605 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1606 // conversion, but complain about it.
1607 ConvertedType = ToType;
1608 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1609 return true;
1610 }
1611 }
1612
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001613 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001614}
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001615
1616/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1617/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1618/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1619/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
1620bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FunctionProtoType* OldType,
1621 FunctionProtoType* NewType){
1622 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1623 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1624 NewType->arg_type_begin());
1625
1626 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1627 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1628 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1629 QualType ToType = (*O);
1630 QualType FromType = (*N);
1631 if (ToType != FromType) {
1632 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1633 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001634 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1635 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1636 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1637 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001638 continue;
1639 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001640 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1641 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
1642 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
1643 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1644 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1645 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001646 }
1647 return false;
1648 }
1649 }
1650 return true;
1651}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001652
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001653/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
1654/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00001655/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001656/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
1657/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
1658/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001659bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001660 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00001661 CXXBaseSpecifierArray& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001662 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001663 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1664
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001665 if (CXXBoolLiteralExpr* LitBool
1666 = dyn_cast<CXXBoolLiteralExpr>(From->IgnoreParens()))
1667 if (LitBool->getValue() == false)
1668 Diag(LitBool->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_init_pointer_from_false)
1669 << ToType;
1670
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001671 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1672 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001673 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
1674 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00001675
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001676 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
1677 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001678 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
1679 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001680 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
1681 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00001682 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001683 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001684 return true;
1685
1686 // The conversion was successful.
1687 Kind = CastExpr::CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001688 }
1689 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001690 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001691 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001692 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001693 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001694 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
1695 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
1696 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001697 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001698 return false;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001699
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001700 }
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001701 return false;
1702}
1703
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001704/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1705/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
1706/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
1707/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
1708/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
1709bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001710 QualType ToType,
1711 bool InOverloadResolution,
1712 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001713 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001714 if (!ToTypePtr)
1715 return false;
1716
1717 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001718 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1719 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1720 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001721 ConvertedType = ToType;
1722 return true;
1723 }
1724
1725 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001726 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001727 if (!FromTypePtr)
1728 return false;
1729
1730 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
1731 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
1732 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
1733 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
1734 // FIXME: What happens when these are dependent? Is this function even called?
1735
1736 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
1737 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
1738 ToClass.getTypePtr());
1739 return true;
1740 }
1741
1742 return false;
1743}
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001744
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001745/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
1746/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001747/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001748/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
1749/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
1750/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001751bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001752 CastExpr::CastKind &Kind,
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001753 CXXBaseSpecifierArray &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001754 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001755 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001756 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001757 if (!FromPtrType) {
1758 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001759 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1760 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001761 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
1762 Kind = CastExpr::CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001763 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001764 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001765
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001766 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001767 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
1768 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001769
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001770 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
1771 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001772
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001773 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
1774 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
1775 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001776
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001777 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00001778 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001779 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
1780 assert(DerivationOkay &&
1781 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
1782 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001783
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001784 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
1785 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001786 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
1787 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
1788 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
1789 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001790 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001791
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001792 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001793 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
1794 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
1795 << From->getSourceRange();
1796 return true;
1797 }
1798
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001799 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00001800 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
1801 Paths.front(),
1802 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00001803
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001804 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00001805 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00001806 Kind = CastExpr::CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001807 return false;
1808}
1809
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001810/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
1811/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
1812/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001813bool
1814Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001815 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1816 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1817
1818 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
1819 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00001820 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001821 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00001822
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001823 // (C++ 4.4p4):
1824 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
1825 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
1826 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001827 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00001828 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001829 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
1830 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
1831 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00001832 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001833 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
1834 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001835 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001836
1837 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
1838 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregorea2d4212008-10-22 00:38:21 +00001839 if (!ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001840 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001841
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001842 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
1843 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
1844 if (FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001845 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001846 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001847
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001848 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
1849 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001851 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00001852 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001853
1854 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
1855 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
1856 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
1857 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
1858 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001859 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00001860}
1861
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00001862/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
1863/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
1864/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
1865/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
1866/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
1867/// false and User is unspecified.
1868///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00001869/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
1870/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
1871/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00001872OverloadingResult Sema::IsUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1873 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001874 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
1875 bool AllowExplicit) {
1876 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
1877 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
1878
1879 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
1880 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001881 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001882 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
1883 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
1884 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
1885 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
1886 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
1887 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
1888 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
1889 // the parentheses of the initializer.
1890 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
1891 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1892 IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
1893 ConstructorsOnly = true;
1894
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00001895 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, PDiag())) {
1896 // We're not going to find any constructors.
1897 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
1898 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001899 DeclarationName ConstructorName
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001900 = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001901 Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType());
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001902 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd)
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00001904 = ToRecordDecl->lookup(ConstructorName);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001905 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001906 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
1907 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
1908
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001909 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
1910 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
1911 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001912 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001913 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001914 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001915 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
1916 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001917 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00001918
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00001919 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00001920 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001921 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001922 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00001923 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00001924 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001925 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/!ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001926 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00001927 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
1928 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001929 AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00001930 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001931 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/!ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00001932 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00001933 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001934 }
1935 }
1936
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001937 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
1938 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001939 } else if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001940 PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00001941 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001942 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001943 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001945 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
1946 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00001947 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00001948 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00001949 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001950 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001951 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
1952 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00001953 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
1954 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1955 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1956
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001957 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
1958 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00001959 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
1960 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001961 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00001962 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001963
1964 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
1965 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001966 AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00001967 ActingContext, From, ToType,
1968 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001969 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00001970 AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00001971 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00001972 }
1973 }
1974 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00001975 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001976
1977 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001978 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, From->getLocStart(), Best)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001979 case OR_Success:
1980 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001981 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001982 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
1983 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
1984 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
1985 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
1986 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
1987 // the argument of the constructor.
1988 //
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001989 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(Context);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001990 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00001991 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
1992 else {
1993 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
1994 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
1995 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001996 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
1997 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001998 User.After.setFromType(
1999 ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002000 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002001 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002002 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2003 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2004 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2005 //
2006 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2007 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2008 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2009 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2010 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2011 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002012 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002013
2014 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002015 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2016 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2017 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2018 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2019 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2020 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2021 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2022 // 13.3.3.1).
2023 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002024 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002025 } else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002026 assert(false && "Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002027 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002028 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002029
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002030 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002031 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002032 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002033 // No conversion here! We're done.
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002034 return OR_Deleted;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002035
2036 case OR_Ambiguous:
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002037 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002038 }
2039
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002040 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002041}
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002042
2043bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002044Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002045 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002046 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002047 OverloadingResult OvResult =
2048 IsUserDefinedConversion(From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002049 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002050 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2051 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2052 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2053 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2054 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2055 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2056 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2057 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2058 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002059 return false;
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00002060 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002061 return true;
2062}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002063
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002064/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2065/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2066/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002067ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002068Sema::CompareImplicitConversionSequences(const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2069 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
2070{
2071 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2072 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2073 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2074 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2075 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2076 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2077 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2078 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002079 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002080 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2081 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2082 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2083 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2084 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002085 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2086 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2087 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2088 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002089
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002090 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2091 // the same kind.
2092 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2093 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2094
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002095 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2096 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2097 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002098 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002099 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002100 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002101 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2102 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2103 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2104 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2105 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2106 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002107 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002108 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
2109 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(ICS1.UserDefined.After,
2110 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2111 }
2112
2113 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2114}
2115
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002116static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2117 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2118 Qualifiers Quals;
2119 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
2120 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
2121 }
2122
2123 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2124}
2125
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002126// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2127// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2128static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2129compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2130 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2131 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2132 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2133 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2134
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002135 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
2136 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2137 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2138 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2139 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2140 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2141 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2142 }
2143
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002144 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2145 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2146 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2147 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2148 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2149 else
2150 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002151 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002152 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2153
2154 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2155 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2156 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2157 }
2158
2159 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2160 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2161 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2162 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2163
2164 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2165 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2166 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2167 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2168
2169 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2170}
2171
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002172/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2173/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2174/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002176Sema::CompareStandardConversionSequences(const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2177 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
2178{
2179 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2180 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2181
2182 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2183 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2184 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2185 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2186 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002187 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
2188 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(Context, SCS1, SCS2))
2189 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002190
2191 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2192 // defined below), or, if not that,
2193 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2194 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2195 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2196 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2197 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2198 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002199
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002200 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2201 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2202 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002203
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002204 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2205 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2206 // that is such a conversion.
2207 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2208 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2209 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2210 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2211
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002212 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2213 //
2214 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002215 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2216 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2217 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002218 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002219 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002220 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002221 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002222 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2223 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2224 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002225 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2226 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002227 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2228 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2229 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002230 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
2231 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(SCS1, SCS2))
2232 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002233 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2234 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2235 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2236 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002237 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2238 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002239
2240 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2241 // conversion, if we need to.
2242 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2243 FromType1 = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
2244 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2245 FromType2 = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
2246
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002247 QualType FromPointee1
2248 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2249 QualType FromPointee2
2250 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002251
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002252 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
2253 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2254 else if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
2255 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2256
2257 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2258 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002259 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2260 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002261 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
2262 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
2263 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2264 else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
2265 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2266 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002267 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002268
2269 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2270 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002272 = CompareQualificationConversions(SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002273 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002274
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002275 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002276 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2277 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2278 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
2279 // without a ref-qualifier, and S1 binds an rvalue reference to an
2280 // rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference.
Sebastian Redl4c0cd852009-03-29 15:27:50 +00002281 // FIXME: We don't know if we're dealing with the implicit object parameter,
2282 // or if the member function in this case has a ref qualifier.
2283 // (Of course, we don't have ref qualifiers yet.)
2284 if (SCS1.RRefBinding != SCS2.RRefBinding)
2285 return SCS1.RRefBinding ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2286 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002287
2288 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2289 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2290 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2291 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2292 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2293 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002294 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2295 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002296 T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2297 T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002298 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2299 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2300 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2301 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
2302 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2303 // for comparison.
2304 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2305 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2306 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2307 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002308 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2309 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2310 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2311 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2312 }
2313 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002314
2315 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2316}
2317
2318/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2319/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002320/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2321ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002322Sema::CompareQualificationConversions(const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002323 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002324 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002325 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2326 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2327 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2328 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2329 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2330 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2331 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2332 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2333
2334 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2335 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002336 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2337 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002338 T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2339 T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002340 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2341 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2342 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002343
2344 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2345 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002346 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002347 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2348
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002349 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2350 // for comparison.
2351 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2352 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2353 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2354 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
2355
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002356 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002357 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002358 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002359 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2360 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2361 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002362 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002363 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2364 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2365 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2366 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2367 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2368 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2369 // about how the sequences rank.
2370 ;
2371 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2372 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2373 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2374 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2375 // qualifiers.
2376 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002377
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002378 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2379 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2380 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2381 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2382 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2383 // qualifiers.
2384 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002385
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002386 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2387 } else {
2388 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2389 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2390 }
2391
2392 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002393 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002394 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002395 }
2396
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002397 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2398 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2399 switch (Result) {
2400 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002401 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002402 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2403 break;
2404
2405 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2406 break;
2407
2408 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002409 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002410 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2411 break;
2412 }
2413
2414 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002415}
2416
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002417/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2418/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002419/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2420/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2421/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002422ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2423Sema::CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2424 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002425 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002426 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002427 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002428 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002429
2430 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2431 // conversion, if we need to.
2432 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2433 FromType1 = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
2434 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2435 FromType2 = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
2436
2437 // Canonicalize all of the types.
2438 FromType1 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2439 ToType1 = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2440 FromType2 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2441 ToType2 = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
2442
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002443 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002444 //
2445 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2446 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002447 //
2448 // For Objective-C, we let A, B, and C also be Objective-C
2449 // interfaces.
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002450
2451 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002452 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002453 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2454 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2455 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2456 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002457 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002458 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002459 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002460 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002461 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002462 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002463 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002464 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002465
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002466 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2467 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2468 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface1 = ToPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2469 const ObjCObjectType* ToIface2 = ToPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002470
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002471 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002472 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
2473 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
2474 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2475 else if (IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
2476 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002477
2478 if (ToIface1 && ToIface2) {
2479 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface2, ToIface1))
2480 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2481 else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToIface1, ToIface2))
2482 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2483 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002484 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002485
2486 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2487 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
2488 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
2489 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2490 else if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
2491 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002492
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002493 if (FromIface1 && FromIface2) {
2494 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
2495 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2496 else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
2497 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2498 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002499 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002500 }
2501
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002502 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002503 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2504 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2505 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
2506 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
2507 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2508 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
2509 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2510 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
2511 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2512 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
2513 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2514 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2515 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2516 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2517 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2518 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2519 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2520 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2521 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002522 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002523 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
2524 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
2525 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2526 else if (IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
2527 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2528 }
2529 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2530 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
2531 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
2532 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2533 else if (IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
2534 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2535 }
2536 }
2537
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002538 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002539 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002540 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2541 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2542 // reference of type A&,
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002543 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2544 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002545 if (IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
2546 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2547 else if (IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
2548 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2549 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002550
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002551 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002552 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2553 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2554 // reference of type A&,
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002555 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2556 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002557 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
2558 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2559 else if (IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
2560 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2561 }
2562 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002563
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002564 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2565}
2566
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002567/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
2568/// determine whether they are reference-related,
2569/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
2570/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
2571/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
2572/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
2573/// type being initialized.
2574Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
2575Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
2576 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
2577 bool& DerivedToBase) {
2578 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
2579 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
2580 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
2581
2582 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
2583 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
2584 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2585 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2586 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2587
2588 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2589 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
2590 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
2591 // T1 is a base class of T2.
2592 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
2593 DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor496e8b342010-05-07 19:42:26 +00002594 else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002595 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
2596 DerivedToBase = true;
2597 else
2598 return Ref_Incompatible;
2599
2600 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
2601 // least).
2602
2603 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2604 // for comparison.
2605 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2606 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2607 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2608 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
2609
2610 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2611 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
2612 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
2613 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
2614 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
2615 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
2616 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
2617 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
2618 return Ref_Compatible;
2619 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2620 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
2621 else
2622 return Ref_Related;
2623}
2624
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002625/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an lvalue reference-compatible
2626/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
2627static bool
2628FindConversionToLValue(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
2629 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2630 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowExplicit) {
2631 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
2632 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
2633 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2634
2635 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
2636 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
2637 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
2638 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
2639 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
2640 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2641 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2642 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2643 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2644
2645 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
2646 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2647 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2648 if (ConvTemplate)
2649 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
2650 else
2651 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
2652
2653 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
2654 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
2655 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
2656 const ReferenceType *RefType =
2657 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2658 if (RefType && (RefType->isLValueReferenceType() ||
2659 RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) &&
2660 (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit())) {
2661 if (ConvTemplate)
2662 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
2663 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
2664 else
2665 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
2666 DeclType, CandidateSet);
2667 }
2668 }
2669
2670 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2671 switch (S.BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, DeclLoc, Best)) {
2672 case OR_Success:
2673 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
2674 //
2675 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
2676 // applying a conversion function to the argument
2677 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
2678 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
2679 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
2680 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
2681 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
2682 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
2683 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
2684 return false;
2685
2686 ICS.setUserDefined();
2687 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2688 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2689 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
2690 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
2691 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
2692 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
2693 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
2694 return true;
2695
2696 case OR_Ambiguous:
2697 ICS.setAmbiguous();
2698 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
2699 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
2700 if (Cand->Viable)
2701 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
2702 return true;
2703
2704 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2705 case OR_Deleted:
2706 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
2707 // conversion; continue with other checks.
2708 return false;
2709 }
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00002710
2711 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002712}
2713
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002714/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
2715/// initialization.
2716static ImplicitConversionSequence
2717TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
2718 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
2719 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00002720 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002721 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
2722
2723 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
2724 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
2725 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
2726
2727 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
2728 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
2729
2730 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
2731 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
2732 // type of the resulting function.
2733 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
2734 DeclAccessPair Found;
2735 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
2736 false, Found))
2737 T2 = Fn->getType();
2738 }
2739
2740 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
2741 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
2742 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002743 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002744 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
2745 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase);
2746
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002747
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002748 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00002749 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
2750 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
2751
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002752 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
2753 // The next bullet point (T1 is a function) is pretty much equivalent to this
2754 // one, so it's handled here.
2755 if (!isRValRef || T1->isFunctionType()) {
2756 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
2757 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
2758 //
2759 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
2760 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
2761 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002762 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002763 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
2764 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
2765 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
2766 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
2767 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
2768 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
2769 ICS.setStandard();
2770 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
2771 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base : ICK_Identity;
2772 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
2773 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
2774 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
2775 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
2776 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
2777 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
2778 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
2779 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2780 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002781
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002782 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
2783 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
2784 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
2785 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002786 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002787 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002788
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002789 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
2790 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
2791 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
2792 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
2793 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
2794 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
2795 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
2796 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
2797 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
2798 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
2799 if (FindConversionToLValue(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
2800 Init, T2, AllowExplicit))
2801 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002802 }
2803 }
2804
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002805 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
2806 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
2807 // shall be an rvalue reference and the initializer expression shall be
2808 // an rvalue or have a function type.
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00002809 //
2810 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
2811 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
2812 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
2813 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
2814 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
2815 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
2816 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002817 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
2818 // go together.
2819 if ((!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified()) ||
2820 (isRValRef && InitCategory.isLValue()))
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002821 return ICS;
2822
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002823 // -- If T1 is a function type, then
2824 // -- if T2 is the same type as T1, the reference is bound to the
2825 // initializer expression lvalue;
2826 // -- if T2 is a class type and the initializer expression can be
2827 // implicitly converted to an lvalue of type T1 [...], the
2828 // reference is bound to the function lvalue that is the result
2829 // of the conversion;
2830 // This is the same as for the lvalue case above, so it was handled there.
2831 // -- otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
2832 // This is the one difference to the lvalue case.
2833 if (T1->isFunctionType())
2834 return ICS;
2835
2836 // -- Otherwise, if T2 is a class type and
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002837 // -- the initializer expression is an rvalue and "cv1 T1"
2838 // is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002839 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002840 // -- T1 is not reference-related to T2 and the initializer
2841 // expression can be implicitly converted to an rvalue
2842 // of type "cv3 T3" (this conversion is selected by
2843 // enumerating the applicable conversion functions
2844 // (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best one through overload
2845 // resolution (13.3)),
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002846 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002847 // then the reference is bound to the initializer
2848 // expression rvalue in the first case and to the object
2849 // that is the result of the conversion in the second case
2850 // (or, in either case, to the appropriate base class
2851 // subobject of the object).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002852 //
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002853 // We're only checking the first case here, which is a direct
2854 // binding in C++0x but not in C++03.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00002855 if (InitCategory.isRValue() && T2->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002856 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
2857 ICS.setStandard();
2858 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
2859 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base : ICK_Identity;
2860 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
2861 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
2862 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
2863 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
2864 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
2865 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf93df192010-04-18 08:46:23 +00002866 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002867 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2868 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
2869 return ICS;
2870 }
2871
2872 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
2873 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
2874 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
2875 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
2876 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
2877 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
2878 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
2879 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
2880 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
2881 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
2882 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
2883 // initialization fails.
2884 return ICS;
2885 }
2886
2887 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
2888 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
2889 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
2890 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
2891 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
2892 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
2893 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
2894 return ICS;
2895
2896 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002897 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
2898 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
2899 // required to convert the argument expression to the
2900 // underlying type of the reference according to
2901 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
2902 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
2903 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
2904 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
2905 // and does not constitute a conversion.
2906 ICS = S.TryImplicitConversion(Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
2907 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002908 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
2909
2910 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
2911 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
2912 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
2913 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2914 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
2915 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
2916 ICS.UserDefined.After.RRefBinding = isRValRef;
2917 }
2918 return ICS;
2919}
2920
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00002921/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
2922/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
2923/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
2924/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002925/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00002926/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00002927static ImplicitConversionSequence
2928TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregordcd27ff2010-04-16 17:53:55 +00002929 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00002930 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002931 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00002932 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002933 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
2934 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00002935 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002936
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00002937 return S.TryImplicitConversion(From, ToType,
2938 SuppressUserConversions,
2939 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00002940 InOverloadResolution);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00002941}
2942
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002943/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
2944/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
2945/// expression @p From.
2946ImplicitConversionSequence
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00002947Sema::TryObjectArgumentInitialization(QualType OrigFromType,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002948 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
2949 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
2950 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00002951 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
2952 // const volatile object.
2953 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
2954 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
2955 QualType ImplicitParamType = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002956
2957 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
2958 // to exit early.
2959 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002960
2961 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00002962 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002963 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00002964 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
2965
2966 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002967
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00002968 // The implicit object parameter is has the type "reference to cv X",
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002969 // where X is the class of which the function is a member
2970 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p4). However, when finding an implicit
2971 // conversion sequence for the argument, we are not allowed to
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002972 // create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002973 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
2974 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
2975 // non-constant references.
2976
2977 // First check the qualifiers. We don't care about lvalue-vs-rvalue
2978 // with the implicit object parameter (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5).
2979 QualType FromTypeCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002980 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
2981 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00002982 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00002983 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
2984 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002985 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00002986 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002987
2988 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
2989 // affects the conversion rank.
2990 QualType ClassTypeCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00002991 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
2992 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
2993 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
2994 } else if (IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
2995 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00002996 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00002997 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
2998 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00002999 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003000 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003001
3002 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003003 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003004 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3005 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003006 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003007 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003008 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3009 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Sebastian Redlf69a94a2009-03-29 22:46:24 +00003010 ICS.Standard.RRefBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003011 return ICS;
3012}
3013
3014/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3015/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3016/// expression.
3017bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003018Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *&From,
3019 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003020 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003021 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003022 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003023 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003024 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003025
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003026 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003027 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3028 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
3029 } else {
3030 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3031 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
3032 }
3033
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003034 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3035 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003036 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003037 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(From->getType(), Method,
3038 Method->getParent());
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003039 if (ICS.isBad())
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003040 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003041 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003042 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003043
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003044 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003045 return PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003046
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003047 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
Anders Carlsson0c509ee2010-04-24 16:57:13 +00003048 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CastExpr::CK_NoOp,
3049 /*isLvalue=*/!From->getType()->isPointerType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003050 return false;
3051}
3052
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003053/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3054/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
3055ImplicitConversionSequence Sema::TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003056 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003057 return TryImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003058 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3059 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003060 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003061 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003062}
3063
3064/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3065/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
3066bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *&From) {
3067 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003068 if (!ICS.isBad())
3069 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003070
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003071 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003072 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3073 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
3074 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
3075 return true;
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003076}
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003077
3078/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3079/// expression From to 'id'.
3080ImplicitConversionSequence Sema::TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003081 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
3082 return TryImplicitConversion(From, Ty,
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003083 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3084 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3085 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
3086 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
3087}
3088
3089/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3090/// of the expression From to 'id'.
3091bool Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *&From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003092 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003093 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(From);
3094 if (!ICS.isBad())
3095 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
3096 return true;
3097}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003098
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003099/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
3100/// enumeration type.
3101///
3102/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3103/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3104/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3105///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003106/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3107/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003108///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003109/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3110///
3111/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3112/// have integral or enumeration type.
3113///
3114/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3115/// incomplete class type.
3116///
3117/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3118/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3119/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3120///
3121/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3122/// showing which conversion was picked.
3123///
3124/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3125/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3126///
3127/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
3128/// usable conversion function.
3129///
3130/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3131/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3132///
3133/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3134/// successful.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003135Sema::OwningExprResult
3136Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, ExprArg FromE,
3137 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3138 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3139 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3140 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3141 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003142 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3143 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003144 Expr *From = static_cast<Expr *>(FromE.get());
3145
3146 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3147 if (From->isTypeDependent())
3148 return move(FromE);
3149
3150 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3151 QualType T = From->getType();
3152 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
3153 return move(FromE);
3154
3155 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3156
3157 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
3158 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3159 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3160 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3161 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3162 << T << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003163 return move(FromE);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003164 }
3165
3166 // We must have a complete class type.
3167 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003168 return move(FromE);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003169
3170 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3171 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3172 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3173 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3174 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3175
3176 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3177 E = Conversions->end();
3178 I != E;
3179 ++I) {
3180 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3181 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3182 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3183 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3184 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3185 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3186 else
3187 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3188 }
3189 }
3190
3191 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3192 case 0:
3193 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3194 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3195 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3196 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3197
3198 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3199 // conversion; use it.
3200 QualType ConvTy
3201 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3202 std::string TypeStr;
3203 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
3204
3205 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3206 << T << ConvTy
3207 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3208 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3209 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3210 ")");
3211 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3212 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3213
3214 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
3215 // explicit conversion function.
3216 if (isSFINAEContext())
3217 return ExprError();
3218
3219 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
3220 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(FromE.takeAs<Expr>(), Found, Conversion);
3221 FromE = Owned(From);
3222 }
3223
3224 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3225 break;
3226
3227 case 1: {
3228 // Apply this conversion.
3229 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3230 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003231
3232 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3233 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3234 QualType ConvTy
3235 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3236 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3237 if (isSFINAEContext())
3238 return ExprError();
3239
3240 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3241 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3242 }
3243
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003244 From = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(FromE.takeAs<Expr>(), Found,
3245 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
3246 FromE = Owned(From);
3247 break;
3248 }
3249
3250 default:
3251 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3252 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3253 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3254 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3255 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3256 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3257 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3258 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3259 }
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003260 return move(FromE);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003261 }
3262
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003263 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003264 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3265 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003266
3267 return move(FromE);
3268}
3269
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003270/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003271/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3272/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3273/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003274///
3275/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3276/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3277/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003278void
3279Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003280 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003281 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003282 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003283 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003284 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003285 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003286 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003287 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003288 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003289 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003290
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003291 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003292 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3293 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3294 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3295 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3296 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003297 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3298 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3299 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003300 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003301 QualType(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003302 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003303 return;
3304 }
3305 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3306 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003307 }
3308
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003309 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003310 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003311
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003312 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
3313 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Action::Unevaluated);
3314
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003315 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3316 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3317 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3318 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3319 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
3320 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
3321 Constructor->isCopyConstructorLikeSpecialization() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003322 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3323 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003324 return;
3325 }
3326
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003327 // Add this candidate
3328 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3329 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003330 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003331 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003332 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003333 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003334 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003335
3336 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3337
3338 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3339 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3340 // list (8.3.5).
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003341 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
3342 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003343 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003344 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003345 return;
3346 }
3347
3348 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3349 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3350 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3351 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3352 // exactly m parameters.
3353 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003354 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003355 // Not enough arguments.
3356 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003357 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003358 return;
3359 }
3360
3361 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3362 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003363 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3364 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3365 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3366 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3367 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3368 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3369 // parameter of F.
3370 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003371 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003372 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00003373 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003374 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003375 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3376 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003377 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003378 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003379 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003380 } else {
3381 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3382 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3383 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003384 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003385 }
3386 }
3387}
3388
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003389/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3390/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003391void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003392 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3393 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3394 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003395 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003396 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3397 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003398 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003399 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003400 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
3401 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003402 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3403 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003404 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003405 SuppressUserConversions);
3406 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003407 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003408 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3409 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003410 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003411 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003412 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003413 Args[0]->getType(), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003414 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003415 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003416 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003417 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003418 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003419 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
3420 SuppressUserConversions);
3421 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003422 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003423}
3424
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003425/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
3426/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003427void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003428 QualType ObjectType,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003429 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3430 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003431 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003432 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003433 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003434
3435 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
3436 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
3437
3438 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
3439 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3440 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003441 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3442 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003443 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003444 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003445 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003446 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003447 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003448 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003449 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003450 }
3451}
3452
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003453/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
3454/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
3455/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
3456/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
3457/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
3458/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003459/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003460void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003461Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003462 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
3463 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003464 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003465 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003466 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003467 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003468 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003469 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
3470 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003471
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003472 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
3473 return;
3474
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003475 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
3476 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Action::Unevaluated);
3477
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003478 // Add this candidate
3479 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3480 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003481 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003482 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003483 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003484 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003485
3486 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3487
3488 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3489 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3490 // list (8.3.5).
3491 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
3492 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003493 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003494 return;
3495 }
3496
3497 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3498 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3499 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3500 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3501 // exactly m parameters.
3502 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
3503 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
3504 // Not enough arguments.
3505 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003506 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003507 return;
3508 }
3509
3510 Candidate.Viable = true;
3511 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
3512
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003513 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003514 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
3515 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
3516 else {
3517 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
3518 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003519 Candidate.Conversions[0]
3520 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectType, Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003521 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003522 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003523 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003524 return;
3525 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003526 }
3527
3528 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3529 // arguments.
3530 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3531 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3532 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3533 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3534 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3535 // parameter of F.
3536 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003537 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003538 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003539 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00003540 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003541 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003542 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003543 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003544 break;
3545 }
3546 } else {
3547 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3548 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3549 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003550 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003551 }
3552 }
3553}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00003554
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003555/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
3556/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
3557/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003558void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003559Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003560 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003561 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003562 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003563 QualType ObjectType,
3564 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003565 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003566 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003567 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
3568 return;
3569
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003570 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003571 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003572 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003573 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003574 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3575 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3576 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3577 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3578 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003579 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003580 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3581 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003582 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003583 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003584 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3585 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
3586 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
3587 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
3588 Candidate.Viable = false;
3589 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
3590 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3591 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
3592 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3593 Info);
3594 return;
3595 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003596
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003597 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3598 // deduction as a candidate.
3599 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003600 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003601 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003602 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003603 ActingContext, ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003604 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00003605}
3606
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003607/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
3608/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
3609/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003610void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003611Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003612 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003613 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003614 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3615 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003616 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003617 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
3618 return;
3619
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003620 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003621 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003622 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003623 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003624 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
3625 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
3626 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
3627 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
3628 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003629 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003630 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3631 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003632 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003633 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003634 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3635 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003636 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003637 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
3638 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003639 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00003640 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3641 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003642 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3643 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003644 return;
3645 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003646
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003647 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
3648 // deduction as a candidate.
3649 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003650 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003651 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003652}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003653
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003654/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003655/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003656/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003657/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003658/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
3659/// conversion function produces).
3660void
3661Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003662 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003663 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003664 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3665 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003666 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
3667 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003668 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003669 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
3670 return;
3671
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003672 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
3673 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Action::Unevaluated);
3674
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003675 // Add this candidate
3676 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3677 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003678 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003679 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003680 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003681 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003682 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003683 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003684 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003685
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003686 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
3687 // object parameter.
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003688 Candidate.Viable = true;
3689 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003690 Candidate.Conversions[0]
3691 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(From->getType(), Conversion,
3692 ActingContext);
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00003693 // Conversion functions to a different type in the base class is visible in
3694 // the derived class. So, a derived to base conversion should not participate
3695 // in overload resolution.
3696 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base)
3697 Candidate.Conversions[0].Standard.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003698 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003699 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003700 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003701 return;
3702 }
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003703
3704 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
3705 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
3706 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
3707 QualType FromCanon
3708 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
3709 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
3710 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
3711 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003712 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00003713 return;
3714 }
3715
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003716 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
3717 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
3718 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
3719 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
3720 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
3721 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
3722 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
3723 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003724 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00003725 From->getLocStart());
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003726 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00003727 CastExpr::CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
Anders Carlsson0c509ee2010-04-24 16:57:13 +00003728 &ConversionRef, CXXBaseSpecifierArray(), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003729
3730 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003731 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
3732 // allocator).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003733 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003734 Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType(),
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00003735 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003737 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00003738 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003739 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003740
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003741 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003742 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
3743 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00003744
3745 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
3746 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
3747 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
3748 // shall have exact match rank.
3749 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
3750 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
3751 Candidate.Viable = false;
3752 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
3753 }
3754
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003755 break;
3756
3757 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
3758 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003759 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003760 break;
3761
3762 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003763 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003764 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
3765 }
3766}
3767
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003768/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
3769/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
3770/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
3771/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
3772/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003773void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003774Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003775 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003776 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003777 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3778 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
3779 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3780 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
3781
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003782 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
3783 return;
3784
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003785 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003786 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
3787 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003788 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003789 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00003790 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3791 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
3792 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
3793 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
3794 Candidate.Viable = false;
3795 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
3796 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
3797 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
3798 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
3799 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003800 return;
3801 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003802
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003803 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
3804 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
3805 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003806 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00003807 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00003808}
3809
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003810/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
3811/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
3812/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
3813/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
3814/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
3815void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003816 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003817 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003818 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003819 QualType ObjectType,
3820 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003821 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003822 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
3823 return;
3824
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003825 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
3826 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Action::Unevaluated);
3827
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003828 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3829 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003830 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003831 Candidate.Function = 0;
3832 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
3833 Candidate.Viable = true;
3834 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003835 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003836 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
3837
3838 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
3839 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003840 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003841 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectType, Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003842 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003843 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003844 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00003845 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003846 return;
3847 }
3848
3849 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
3850 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
3851 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003852 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003853 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00003854 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003855 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003856 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003857 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
3858 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3859
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003860 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003861 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3862
3863 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3864 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3865 // list (8.3.5).
3866 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
3867 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003868 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003869 return;
3870 }
3871
3872 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
3873 // we have enough arguments.
3874 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3875 // Not enough arguments.
3876 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003877 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003878 return;
3879 }
3880
3881 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3882 // arguments.
3883 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3884 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3885 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3886 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3887 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3888 // parameter of F.
3889 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003890 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003891 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00003892 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003893 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003894 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003895 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003896 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003897 break;
3898 }
3899 } else {
3900 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3901 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3902 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003903 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003904 }
3905 }
3906}
3907
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003908/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
3909/// member functions.
3910///
3911/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
3912/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
3913/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
3914/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
3915/// [over.match.oper]).
3916void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
3917 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3918 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3919 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3920 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003921 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
3922
3923 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
3924 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
3925 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
3926 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
3927 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
3928 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
3929 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
3930 // constructed as follows:
3931 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
3932 QualType T2;
3933 if (NumArgs > 1)
3934 T2 = Args[1]->getType();
3935
3936 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
3937 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
3938 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
3939 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003940 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00003941 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003942 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00003943 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003944
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00003945 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
3946 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
3947 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
3948
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003949 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00003950 OperEnd = Operators.end();
3951 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003952 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003953 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003954 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003955 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003956 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003957}
3958
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00003959/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
3960/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
3961/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00003962/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
3963/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003964/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
3965/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
3966/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003967void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00003968 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00003969 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003970 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
3971 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003972 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
3973 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Action::Unevaluated);
3974
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00003975 // Add this candidate
3976 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3977 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003978 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00003979 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00003980 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003981 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00003982 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
3983 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
3984 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
3985
3986 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3987 // arguments.
3988 Candidate.Viable = true;
3989 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3990 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00003991 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
3992 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
3993 // left operand are restricted as follows:
3994 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
3995 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
3996 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003997 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00003998 //
3999 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4000 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4001 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4002 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004003 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004004 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004005 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
4006 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx] = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Args[ArgIdx]);
4007 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004008 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004009 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004010 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004011 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004012 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004013 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004014 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004015 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004016 break;
4017 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004018 }
4019}
4020
4021/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4022/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4023/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4024/// enumeration types.
4025class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4026 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004027 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004028
4029 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4030 /// built-in candidates.
4031 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4032
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004033 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4034 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4035 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4036
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004037 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4038 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4039 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4040
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004041 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
4042 /// candidates.
4043 TypeSet VectorTypes;
4044
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004045 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4046 /// candidate type set.
4047 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004048
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004049 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4050 ASTContext &Context;
4051
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004052 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4053 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004054 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004055
4056public:
4057 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004058 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004059
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004060 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004061 : SemaRef(SemaRef), Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004062
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004063 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
4064 SourceLocation Loc,
4065 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004066 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4067 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004068
4069 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4070 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4071
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004072 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004073 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4074
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004075 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4076 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4077
4078 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4079 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4080
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004081 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4082 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4083
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004084 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004085 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004086
4087 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4088 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004089};
4090
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004091/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004092/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4093/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4094/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4095/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4096/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4097/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004098///
4099/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004100bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004101BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4102 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004103
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004104 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004105 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004106 return false;
4107
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004108 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
4109 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a pointer type!");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004110
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004111 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004112 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4113 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4114 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4115 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4116 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4117 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004118 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004119 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004120 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004121 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4122 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
4123
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004124 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4125 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4126 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004127 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4128 // in the types.
4129 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4130 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004131 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
4132 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004133 }
4134
4135 return true;
4136}
4137
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004138/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4139/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4140/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4141/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4142/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4143/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4144/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004145///
4146/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004147bool
4148BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4149 QualType Ty) {
4150 // Insert this type.
4151 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4152 return false;
4153
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004154 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4155 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004156
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004157 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004158 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4159 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4160 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4161 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4162 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4163 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004164 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4165
4166 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4167 // qualifiers.
4168 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4169 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4170 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
4171
4172 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
4173 MemberPointerTypes.insert(Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004174 }
4175
4176 return true;
4177}
4178
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004179/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4180/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004181/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4182/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004183/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4184/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4185/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4186/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004187void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004188BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004189 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004190 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004191 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4192 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004193 // Only deal with canonical types.
4194 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4195
4196 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4197 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004198 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004199 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4200
4201 // We don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004202 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004203
Sebastian Redl65ae2002009-11-05 16:36:20 +00004204 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4205 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4206 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
4207
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004208 if (const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004209 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
4210
4211 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4212 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004213 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004214 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004215 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4216 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4217 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4218 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004219 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004220 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004221 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
4222 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004223 } else if (AllowUserConversions) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004224 if (const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004225 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004226 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4227 return;
4228 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004229
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004230 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004231 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianae01f782009-10-07 17:26:09 +00004232 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004233 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004234 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004235 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4236 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4237 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004238
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004239 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004240 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004241 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004242 continue;
4243
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004244 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004245 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004246 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004247 VisibleQuals);
4248 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004249 }
4250 }
4251 }
4252}
4253
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004254/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4255/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4256/// given type to the candidate set.
4257static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4258 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004259 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004260 unsigned NumArgs,
4261 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4262 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004263
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004264 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4265 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4266 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4267 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4268 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004269
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004270 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4271 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004272 ParamTypes[0]
4273 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004274 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4275 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004276 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004277 }
4278}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004279
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004280/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4281/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004282static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4283 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4284 const RecordType *TyRec;
4285 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4286 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004287 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004288 else
4289 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4290 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004291 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004292 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4293 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4294 return VRQuals;
4295 }
4296
4297 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004298 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4299 return VRQuals;
4300
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004301 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004302 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004303
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004304 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004305 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004306 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4307 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4308 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4309 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004310 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4311 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4312 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4313 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4314 // as see them.
4315 bool done = false;
4316 while (!done) {
4317 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4318 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
4319 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
4320 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4321 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4322 else
4323 done = true;
4324 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4325 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4326 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4327 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4328 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4329 return VRQuals;
4330 }
4331 }
4332 }
4333 return VRQuals;
4334}
4335
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004336/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
4337/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
4338/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
4339/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
4340/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004341void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004342Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004343 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004344 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4345 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004346 // The set of "promoted arithmetic types", which are the arithmetic
4347 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2). Note
4348 // that the first few of these types are the promoted integral
4349 // types; these types need to be first.
4350 // FIXME: What about complex?
4351 const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 0;
4352 const unsigned LastIntegralType = 13;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004353 const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 7,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004354 LastPromotedIntegralType = 13;
4355 const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 7,
4356 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 16;
4357 const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 16;
4358 QualType ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004359 Context.BoolTy, Context.CharTy, Context.WCharTy,
4360// FIXME: Context.Char16Ty, Context.Char32Ty,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004361 Context.SignedCharTy, Context.ShortTy,
4362 Context.UnsignedCharTy, Context.UnsignedShortTy,
4363 Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy,
4364 Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy,
4365 Context.FloatTy, Context.DoubleTy, Context.LongDoubleTy
4366 };
Douglas Gregorb8440a72009-10-21 22:01:30 +00004367 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedIntegralType] == Context.IntTy &&
4368 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
4369 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedIntegralType - 1]
4370 == Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
4371 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
4372 assert(ArithmeticTypes[FirstPromotedArithmeticType] == Context.IntTy &&
4373 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
4374 assert(ArithmeticTypes[LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1]
4375 == Context.LongDoubleTy &&
4376 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
4377
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004378 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
4379 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
4380 // that make use of these types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004381 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
4382 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00004383 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4384 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
4385
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004386 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet CandidateTypes(*this);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004387 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4388 CandidateTypes.AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
4389 OpLoc,
4390 true,
4391 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
4392 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
4393 Op == OO_PipePipe),
4394 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004395
4396 bool isComparison = false;
4397 switch (Op) {
4398 case OO_None:
4399 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
4400 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
4401 break;
4402
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004403 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004404 if (NumArgs == 1)
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004405 goto UnaryStar;
4406 else
4407 goto BinaryStar;
4408 break;
4409
4410 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
4411 if (NumArgs == 1)
4412 goto UnaryPlus;
4413 else
4414 goto BinaryPlus;
4415 break;
4416
4417 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
4418 if (NumArgs == 1)
4419 goto UnaryMinus;
4420 else
4421 goto BinaryMinus;
4422 break;
4423
4424 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
4425 if (NumArgs == 1)
4426 goto UnaryAmp;
4427 else
4428 goto BinaryAmp;
4429
4430 case OO_PlusPlus:
4431 case OO_MinusMinus:
4432 // C++ [over.built]p3:
4433 //
4434 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
4435 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
4436 // functions of the form
4437 //
4438 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
4439 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
4440 //
4441 // C++ [over.built]p4:
4442 //
4443 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
4444 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
4445 // candidate operator functions of the form
4446 //
4447 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
4448 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004449 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004450 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
4451 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004452 QualType ParamTypes[2]
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00004453 = { Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithTy), Context.IntTy };
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004454
4455 // Non-volatile version.
4456 if (NumArgs == 1)
4457 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4458 else
4459 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004460 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
4461 // Add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
4462 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
4463 // Volatile version
4464 ParamTypes[0]
4465 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(ArithTy));
4466 if (NumArgs == 1)
4467 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4468 else
4469 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4470 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004471 }
4472
4473 // C++ [over.built]p5:
4474 //
4475 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
4476 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
4477 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4478 //
4479 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
4480 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
4481 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
4482 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
4483 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4484 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4485 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004486 if (!(*Ptr)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004487 continue;
4488
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004489 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
4490 Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr), Context.IntTy
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004491 };
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004492
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004493 // Without volatile
4494 if (NumArgs == 1)
4495 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4496 else
4497 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4498
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004499 if (!Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
4500 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004501 // With volatile
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004502 ParamTypes[0]
4503 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004504 if (NumArgs == 1)
4505 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4506 else
4507 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4508 }
4509 }
4510 break;
4511
4512 UnaryStar:
4513 // C++ [over.built]p6:
4514 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
4515 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4516 //
4517 // T& operator*(T*);
4518 //
4519 // C++ [over.built]p7:
4520 // For every function type T, there exist candidate operator
4521 // functions of the form
4522 // T& operator*(T*);
4523 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4524 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4525 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004526 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004527 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004528 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4529 }
4530 break;
4531
4532 UnaryPlus:
4533 // C++ [over.built]p8:
4534 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
4535 // the form
4536 //
4537 // T* operator+(T*);
4538 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4539 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4540 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
4541 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4542 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004543
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004544 // Fall through
4545
4546 UnaryMinus:
4547 // C++ [over.built]p9:
4548 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
4549 // operator functions of the form
4550 //
4551 // T operator+(T);
4552 // T operator-(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004553 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004554 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
4555 QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
4556 AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4557 }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004558
4559 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
4560 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Vec = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4561 VecEnd = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4562 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4563 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4564 AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4565 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004566 break;
4567
4568 case OO_Tilde:
4569 // C++ [over.built]p10:
4570 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
4571 // operator functions of the form
4572 //
4573 // T operator~(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004574 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004575 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
4576 QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
4577 AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4578 }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004579
4580 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
4581 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Vec = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4582 VecEnd = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4583 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
4584 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
4585 AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
4586 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004587 break;
4588
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004589 case OO_New:
4590 case OO_Delete:
4591 case OO_Array_New:
4592 case OO_Array_Delete:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004593 case OO_Call:
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004594 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004595 break;
4596
4597 case OO_Comma:
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004598 UnaryAmp:
4599 case OO_Arrow:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004600 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4601 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
4602 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004603 break;
4604
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004605 case OO_EqualEqual:
4606 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
4607 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004608 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
4609 // functions of the form
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004610 //
4611 // bool operator==(T,T);
4612 // bool operator!=(T,T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004613 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004614 MemPtr = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_begin(),
4615 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_end();
4616 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
4617 ++MemPtr) {
4618 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
4619 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4620 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004621
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004622 // Fall through
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004623
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004624 case OO_Less:
4625 case OO_Greater:
4626 case OO_LessEqual:
4627 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004628 // C++ [over.built]p15:
4629 //
4630 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
4631 // candidate operator functions of the form
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004632 //
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004633 // bool operator<(T, T);
4634 // bool operator>(T, T);
4635 // bool operator<=(T, T);
4636 // bool operator>=(T, T);
4637 // bool operator==(T, T);
4638 // bool operator!=(T, T);
4639 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4640 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4641 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
4642 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4643 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004644 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Enum
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004645 = CandidateTypes.enumeration_begin();
4646 Enum != CandidateTypes.enumeration_end(); ++Enum) {
4647 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
4648 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4649 }
4650
4651 // Fall through.
4652 isComparison = true;
4653
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004654 BinaryPlus:
4655 BinaryMinus:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004656 if (!isComparison) {
4657 // We didn't fall through, so we must have OO_Plus or OO_Minus.
4658
4659 // C++ [over.built]p13:
4660 //
4661 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
4662 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004663 //
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004664 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
4665 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
4666 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
4667 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
4668 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
4669 //
4670 // C++ [over.built]p14:
4671 //
4672 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
4673 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4674 //
4675 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004676 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004677 = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4678 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4679 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, Context.getPointerDiffType() };
4680
4681 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
4682 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4683
4684 if (Op == OO_Plus) {
4685 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
4686 ParamTypes[0] = ParamTypes[1];
4687 ParamTypes[1] = *Ptr;
4688 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4689 } else {
4690 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
4691 ParamTypes[1] = *Ptr;
4692 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
4693 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4694 }
4695 }
4696 }
4697 // Fall through
4698
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004699 case OO_Slash:
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004700 BinaryStar:
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004701 Conditional:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004702 // C++ [over.built]p12:
4703 //
4704 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
4705 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4706 //
4707 // LR operator*(L, R);
4708 // LR operator/(L, R);
4709 // LR operator+(L, R);
4710 // LR operator-(L, R);
4711 // bool operator<(L, R);
4712 // bool operator>(L, R);
4713 // bool operator<=(L, R);
4714 // bool operator>=(L, R);
4715 // bool operator==(L, R);
4716 // bool operator!=(L, R);
4717 //
4718 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
4719 // between types L and R.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004720 //
4721 // C++ [over.built]p24:
4722 //
4723 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
4724 // candidate operator functions of the form
4725 //
4726 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
4727 //
4728 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
4729 // between types L and R.
4730 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004731 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004732 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004733 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004734 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
4735 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004736 QualType Result
4737 = isComparison
4738 ? Context.BoolTy
4739 : Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(LandR[0], LandR[1]);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004740 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4741 }
4742 }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004743
4744 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
4745 // conditional operator for vector types.
4746 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Vec1 = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4747 Vec1End = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4748 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1)
4749 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4750 Vec2 = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4751 Vec2End = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4752 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
4753 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
4754 QualType Result;
4755 if (isComparison)
4756 Result = Context.BoolTy;
4757 else {
4758 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
4759 Result = *Vec1;
4760 else
4761 Result = *Vec2;
4762 }
4763
4764 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4765 }
4766
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004767 break;
4768
4769 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004770 BinaryAmp:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004771 case OO_Caret:
4772 case OO_Pipe:
4773 case OO_LessLess:
4774 case OO_GreaterGreater:
4775 // C++ [over.built]p17:
4776 //
4777 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
4778 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
4779 //
4780 // LR operator%(L, R);
4781 // LR operator&(L, R);
4782 // LR operator^(L, R);
4783 // LR operator|(L, R);
4784 // L operator<<(L, R);
4785 // L operator>>(L, R);
4786 //
4787 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
4788 // between types L and R.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004789 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004790 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004791 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004792 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
4793 QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left], ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
4794 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
4795 ? LandR[0]
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004796 : Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(LandR[0], LandR[1]);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004797 AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4798 }
4799 }
4800 break;
4801
4802 case OO_Equal:
4803 // C++ [over.built]p20:
4804 //
4805 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004806 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004807 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4808 //
4809 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004810 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4811 Enum = CandidateTypes.enumeration_begin(),
4812 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes.enumeration_end();
4813 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004814 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(*this, *Enum, Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004815 CandidateSet);
4816 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4817 MemPtr = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_begin(),
4818 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_end();
4819 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004820 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(*this, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004821 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004822
4823 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004824
4825 case OO_PlusEqual:
4826 case OO_MinusEqual:
4827 // C++ [over.built]p19:
4828 //
4829 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
4830 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
4831 // of the form
4832 //
4833 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
4834 //
4835 // C++ [over.built]p21:
4836 //
4837 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
4838 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
4839 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4840 //
4841 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
4842 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
4843 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
4844 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
4845 QualType ParamTypes[2];
4846 ParamTypes[1] = (Op == OO_Equal)? *Ptr : Context.getPointerDiffType();
4847
4848 // non-volatile version
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00004849 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr);
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004850 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4851 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004852
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00004853 if (!Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
4854 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004855 // volatile version
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004856 ParamTypes[0]
4857 = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004858 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4859 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004860 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004861 }
4862 // Fall through.
4863
4864 case OO_StarEqual:
4865 case OO_SlashEqual:
4866 // C++ [over.built]p18:
4867 //
4868 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
4869 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
4870 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
4871 // the form
4872 //
4873 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
4874 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
4875 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
4876 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
4877 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
4878 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004879 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004880 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
4881 QualType ParamTypes[2];
4882 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
4883
4884 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00004885 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004886 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4887 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004888
4889 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00004890 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
4891 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getVolatileType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
4892 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
4893 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4894 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
4895 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004896 }
4897 }
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004898
4899 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
4900 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Vec1 = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4901 Vec1End = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4902 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1)
4903 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
4904 Vec2 = CandidateTypes.vector_begin(),
4905 Vec2End = CandidateTypes.vector_end();
4906 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
4907 QualType ParamTypes[2];
4908 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
4909 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
4910 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
4911 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4912 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
4913
4914 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
4915 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
4916 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
4917 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
4918 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4919 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/Op == OO_Equal);
4920 }
4921 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004922 break;
4923
4924 case OO_PercentEqual:
4925 case OO_LessLessEqual:
4926 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
4927 case OO_AmpEqual:
4928 case OO_CaretEqual:
4929 case OO_PipeEqual:
4930 // C++ [over.built]p22:
4931 //
4932 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
4933 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
4934 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
4935 //
4936 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
4937 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
4938 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
4939 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
4940 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
4941 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
4942 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004943 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004944 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
4945 QualType ParamTypes[2];
4946 ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
4947
4948 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00004949 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArithmeticTypes[Left]);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004950 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahaniana4a93342009-10-20 00:04:40 +00004951 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
4952 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
4953 ParamTypes[0] = ArithmeticTypes[Left];
4954 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
4955 ParamTypes[0] = Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
4956 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
4957 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004958 }
4959 }
4960 break;
4961
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004962 case OO_Exclaim: {
4963 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
4964 //
4965 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
4966 //
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004967 // bool operator!(bool);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004968 // bool operator&&(bool, bool); [BELOW]
4969 // bool operator||(bool, bool); [BELOW]
4970 QualType ParamTy = Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004971 AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
4972 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
4973 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004974 break;
4975 }
4976
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004977 case OO_AmpAmp:
4978 case OO_PipePipe: {
4979 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
4980 //
4981 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
4982 //
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00004983 // bool operator!(bool); [ABOVE]
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004984 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
4985 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
4986 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { Context.BoolTy, Context.BoolTy };
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004987 AddBuiltinCandidate(Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4988 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
4989 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004990 break;
4991 }
4992
4993 case OO_Subscript:
4994 // C++ [over.built]p13:
4995 //
4996 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
4997 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004998 //
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004999 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5000 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5001 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5002 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5003 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5004 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
5005 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
5006 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, Context.getPointerDiffType() };
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005007 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00005008 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005009
5010 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5011 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5012
5013 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5014 ParamTypes[0] = ParamTypes[1];
5015 ParamTypes[1] = *Ptr;
5016 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005017 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005018 break;
5019
5020 case OO_ArrowStar:
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005021 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5022 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5023 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5024 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5025 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5026 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5027 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5028 {
5029 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr =
5030 CandidateTypes.pointer_begin();
5031 Ptr != CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); ++Ptr) {
5032 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5033 QualType C1;
Fariborz Jahanian4dc12462009-10-09 16:34:40 +00005034 QualifierCollector Q1;
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005035 if (const PointerType *PointerTy = C1Ty->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian4dc12462009-10-09 16:34:40 +00005036 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(PointerTy->getPointeeType()), 0);
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005037 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5038 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005039 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5040 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5041 // volatile/restrict type.
5042 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5043 continue;
5044 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5045 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005046 }
5047 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5048 MemPtr = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_begin(),
5049 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_end();
5050 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5051 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5052 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
Fariborz Jahanian12df37c2009-10-07 16:56:50 +00005053 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005054 if (C1 != C2 && !IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5055 break;
5056 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5057 // build CV12 T&
5058 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005059 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5060 T.isVolatileQualified())
5061 continue;
5062 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5063 T.isRestrictQualified())
5064 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian4dc12462009-10-09 16:34:40 +00005065 T = Q1.apply(T);
Fariborz Jahanian34d93dc2009-10-06 23:08:05 +00005066 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5067 AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5068 }
5069 }
5070 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005071 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005072
5073 case OO_Conditional:
5074 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5075 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5076 // therefore added as binary.
5077 //
5078 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5079 // For every type T, where T is a pointer or pointer-to-member type,
5080 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5081 //
5082 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5083 //
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005084 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr = CandidateTypes.pointer_begin(),
5085 E = CandidateTypes.pointer_end(); Ptr != E; ++Ptr) {
5086 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5087 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5088 }
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00005089 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator Ptr =
5090 CandidateTypes.member_pointer_begin(),
5091 E = CandidateTypes.member_pointer_end(); Ptr != E; ++Ptr) {
5092 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5093 AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5094 }
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005095 goto Conditional;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005096 }
5097}
5098
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005099/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
5100/// to the set of overloading candidates.
5101///
5102/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
5103/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
5104/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
5105/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005106void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005107Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005108 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005109 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005110 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005111 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5112 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005113 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005114
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00005115 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
5116 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
5117 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
5118 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
5119 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
5120 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
5121
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005122 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005123 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005124
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005125 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005126 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
5127 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5128 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005129 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005130 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005131 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005132 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005133 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00005134
5135 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
5136 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00005137 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005138 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005139 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00005140 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005141 continue;
5142
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005143 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00005144 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005145 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005146 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005147 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00005148 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005149 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00005150}
5151
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005152/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
5153/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005154bool
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005155Sema::isBetterOverloadCandidate(const OverloadCandidate& Cand1,
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005156 const OverloadCandidate& Cand2,
5157 SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005158 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
5159 // functions.
5160 if (!Cand2.Viable)
5161 return Cand1.Viable;
5162 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
5163 return false;
5164
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005165 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
5166 //
5167 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
5168 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
5169 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
5170 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
5171 unsigned StartArg = 0;
5172 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
5173 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005174
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005175 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005176 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
5177 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005178 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005179 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
5180 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
5181 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005182 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005183 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
5184 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
5185 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5186 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5187 HasBetterConversion = true;
5188 break;
5189
5190 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5191 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5192 return false;
5193
5194 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5195 // Do nothing.
5196 break;
5197 }
5198 }
5199
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005200 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005201 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005202 if (HasBetterConversion)
5203 return true;
5204
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005205 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005206 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00005207 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005208 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
5209 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005210
5211 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
5212 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
5213 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00005214 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00005215 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
5216 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005217 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
5218 = getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
5219 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005220 Loc,
Douglas Gregor6010da02009-09-14 23:02:14 +00005221 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
5222 : TPOC_Call))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005223 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005224
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005225 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
5226 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
5227 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
5228 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
5229 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
5230 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005231 if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
5232 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005233 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
5234 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(Cand1.FinalConversion,
5235 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
5236 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5237 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
5238 return true;
5239
5240 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5241 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
5242 return false;
5243
5244 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5245 // Do nothing
5246 break;
5247 }
5248 }
5249
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005250 return false;
5251}
5252
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005253/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005254/// within an overload candidate set.
5255///
5256/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
5257///
5258/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
5259/// which overload resolution occurs.
5260///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005261/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005262/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
5263///
5264/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00005265OverloadingResult Sema::BestViableFunction(OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5266 SourceLocation Loc,
5267 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator& Best) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005268 // Find the best viable function.
5269 Best = CandidateSet.end();
5270 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
5271 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) {
5272 if (Cand->Viable) {
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005273 if (Best == CandidateSet.end() ||
5274 isBetterOverloadCandidate(*Cand, *Best, Loc))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005275 Best = Cand;
5276 }
5277 }
5278
5279 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
5280 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
5281 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
5282
5283 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
5284 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
5285 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
5286 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005287 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005288 Cand != Best &&
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005289 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(*Best, *Cand, Loc)) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005290 Best = CandidateSet.end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005291 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005292 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005293 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005294
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005295 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005296 if (Best->Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005297 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005298 Best->Function->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00005299 return OR_Deleted;
5300
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005301 // C++ [basic.def.odr]p2:
5302 // An overloaded function is used if it is selected by overload resolution
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005303 // when referred to from a potentially-evaluated expression. [Note: this
5304 // covers calls to named functions (5.2.2), operator overloading
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00005305 // (clause 13), user-defined conversions (12.3.2), allocation function for
5306 // placement new (5.3.4), as well as non-default initialization (8.5).
5307 if (Best->Function)
5308 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Best->Function);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005309 return OR_Success;
5310}
5311
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005312namespace {
5313
5314enum OverloadCandidateKind {
5315 oc_function,
5316 oc_method,
5317 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005318 oc_function_template,
5319 oc_method_template,
5320 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005321 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
5322 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005323 oc_implicit_copy_assignment
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005324};
5325
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005326OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
5327 FunctionDecl *Fn,
5328 std::string &Description) {
5329 bool isTemplate = false;
5330
5331 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
5332 isTemplate = true;
5333 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
5334 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
5335 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005336
5337 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005338 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005339 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005340
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005341 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
5342 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005343 }
5344
5345 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
5346 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
5347 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005348 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005349 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005350
5351 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignment()
5352 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005353 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
5354 }
5355
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005356 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005357}
5358
5359} // end anonymous namespace
5360
5361// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
5362void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005363 std::string FnDesc;
5364 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
5365 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
5366 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00005367}
5368
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005369/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
5370/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
5371/// target types of the conversion.
5372void Sema::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
5373 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
5374 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) {
5375 Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
5376 << ICS.Ambiguous.getFromType() << ICS.Ambiguous.getToType();
5377 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
5378 I = ICS.Ambiguous.begin(), E = ICS.Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
5379 NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
5380 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005381}
5382
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005383namespace {
5384
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005385void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
5386 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
5387 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005388 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
5389 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
5390
5391 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
5392 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
5393 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005394 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005395 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005396 if (I == 0)
5397 isObjectArgument = true;
5398 else
5399 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005400 }
5401
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005402 std::string FnDesc;
5403 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
5404
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005405 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
5406 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
5407 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005408
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005409 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005410 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005411 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
5412 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
5413 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00005414 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00005415
5416 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
5417 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5418 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5419 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
5420 return;
5421 }
5422
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00005423 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
5424 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00005425 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
5426 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
5427 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
5428 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
5429 else {
5430 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
5431 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5432 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5433 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
5434 }
5435
5436 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
5437 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
5438 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
5439 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
5440 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
5441 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
5442 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
5443
5444 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
5445 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
5446
5447 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
5448 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
5449 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5450 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5451 << FromTy
5452 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
5453 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
5454 return;
5455 }
5456
5457 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5458 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
5459
5460 if (isObjectArgument) {
5461 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
5462 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5463 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5464 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
5465 } else {
5466 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
5467 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5468 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5469 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
5470 }
5471 return;
5472 }
5473
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00005474 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
5475 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
5476 // the failure.
5477 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
5478 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5479 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
5480 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
5481 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
5482 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5483 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5484 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
5485 return;
5486 }
5487
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00005488 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
5489 bool IsBaseToDerivedConversion = false;
5490 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5491 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5492 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
5493 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
5494 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
5495 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
5496 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
5497 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
5498 IsBaseToDerivedConversion = true;
5499 }
5500 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
5501 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5502 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
5503 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
5504 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
5505 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
5506 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
5507 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
5508 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
5509 IsBaseToDerivedConversion = true;
5510 }
5511 if (IsBaseToDerivedConversion) {
5512 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
5513 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_ptr_conv)
5514 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
5515 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
5516 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
5517 return;
5518 }
5519
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00005520 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005521 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
5522 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005523 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00005524 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005525}
5526
5527void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
5528 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
5529 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
5530
5531 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
5532 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5533
5534 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
5535
5536 // at least / at most / exactly
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005537 // FIXME: variadic templates "at most" should account for parameter packs
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005538 unsigned mode, modeCount;
5539 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005540 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
5541 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
5542 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005543 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() || FnTy->isVariadic())
5544 mode = 0; // "at least"
5545 else
5546 mode = 2; // "exactly"
5547 modeCount = MinParams;
5548 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005549 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
5550 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
5551 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005552 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
5553 mode = 1; // "at most"
5554 else
5555 mode = 2; // "exactly"
5556 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
5557 }
5558
5559 std::string Description;
5560 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
5561
5562 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005563 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
5564 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005565}
5566
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005567/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
5568void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
5569 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
5570 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
5571
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005572 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00005573 NamedDecl *ParamD;
5574 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
5575 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
5576 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005577 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
5578 case Sema::TDK_Success:
5579 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
5580
5581 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005582 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
5583 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
5584 << ParamD->getDeclName();
5585 return;
5586 }
5587
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005588 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
5589 case Sema::TDK_InconsistentQuals: {
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00005590 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005591 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00005592 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005593 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00005594 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005595 which = 1;
5596 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005597 which = 2;
5598 }
5599
5600 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
5601 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
5602 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
5603 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
5604 return;
5605 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005606
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00005607 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
5608 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
5609 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
5610 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
5611 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
5612 << ParamD->getDeclName();
5613 else {
5614 int index = 0;
5615 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
5616 index = TTP->getIndex();
5617 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
5618 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
5619 index = NTTP->getIndex();
5620 else
5621 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
5622 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
5623 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
5624 << (index + 1);
5625 }
5626 return;
5627
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00005628 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
5629 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
5630 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
5631 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00005632
5633 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
5634 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
5635 return;
5636
5637 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
5638 std::string ArgString;
5639 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
5640 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
5641 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
5642 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
5643 *Args);
5644 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
5645 << ArgString;
5646 return;
5647 }
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00005648
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005649 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
5650 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005651 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005652 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
5653 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
5654 return;
5655 }
5656}
5657
5658/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
5659/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
5660///
5661/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
5662/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
5663/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
5664/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
5665/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
5666/// overload.
5667///
5668/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
5669/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
5670/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005671void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
5672 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005673 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
5674
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005675 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005676 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005677 std::string FnDesc;
5678 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00005679
5680 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005681 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005682 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005683 }
5684
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005685 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
5686 if (Cand->Viable) {
5687 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
5688 return;
5689 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005690
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005691 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
5692 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
5693 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
5694 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005695
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005696 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00005697 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
5698
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005699 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
5700 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00005701 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005702 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005703
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005704 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
5705 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
5706 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005707 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
5708 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
5709
5710 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
5711 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
5712 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
5713 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005714 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005715 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005716}
5717
5718void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
5719 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
5720 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
5721 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
5722 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
5723 bool isLValueReference = false;
5724 bool isRValueReference = false;
5725 bool isPointer = false;
5726 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
5727 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
5728 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
5729 isLValueReference = true;
5730 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
5731 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
5732 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
5733 isRValueReference = true;
5734 }
5735 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5736 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
5737 isPointer = true;
5738 }
5739 // Desugar down to a function type.
5740 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
5741 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
5742 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
5743 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
5744 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
5745
5746 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
5747 << FnType;
5748}
5749
5750void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
5751 const char *Opc,
5752 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5753 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
5754 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
5755 std::string TypeStr("operator");
5756 TypeStr += Opc;
5757 TypeStr += "(";
5758 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
5759 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
5760 TypeStr += ")";
5761 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
5762 } else {
5763 TypeStr += ", ";
5764 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
5765 TypeStr += ")";
5766 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
5767 }
5768}
5769
5770void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
5771 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
5772 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
5773 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
5774 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005775 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
5776 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
5777
5778 S.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(ICS, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00005779 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005780 }
5781}
5782
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00005783SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
5784 if (Cand->Function)
5785 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00005786 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00005787 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
5788 return SourceLocation();
5789}
5790
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00005791struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
5792 Sema &S;
5793 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005794
5795 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
5796 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00005797 // Fast-path this check.
5798 if (L == R) return false;
5799
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005800 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00005801 if (L->Viable) {
5802 if (!R->Viable) return true;
5803
5804 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
5805 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
5806 // that could exploit it.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00005807 if (S.isBetterOverloadCandidate(*L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
5808 if (S.isBetterOverloadCandidate(*R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00005809 } else if (R->Viable)
5810 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005811
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00005812 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005813
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00005814 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
5815 if (!L->Viable) {
5816 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
5817 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
5818 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
5819 return false;
5820 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
5821 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
5822 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005823
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005824 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
5825 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
5826 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
5827 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
5828 return true;
5829
5830 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
5831 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
5832 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
5833
5834 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00005835 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
5836 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005837 switch (S.CompareImplicitConversionSequences(L->Conversions[I],
5838 R->Conversions[I])) {
5839 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
5840 leftBetter++;
5841 break;
5842
5843 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
5844 leftBetter--;
5845 break;
5846
5847 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
5848 break;
5849 }
5850 }
5851 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
5852 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
5853
5854 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
5855 return false;
5856
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00005857 // TODO: others?
5858 }
5859
5860 // Sort everything else by location.
5861 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
5862 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
5863
5864 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
5865 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
5866 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
5867
5868 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005869 }
5870};
5871
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005872/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
5873/// computes up to the first
5874void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
5875 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
5876 assert(!Cand->Viable);
5877
5878 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
5879 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
5880
5881 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005882 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005883 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
5884 while (true) {
5885 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
5886 ConvIdx++;
5887 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
5888 break;
5889 }
5890
5891 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
5892 return;
5893
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00005894 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
5895 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
5896
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00005897 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005898 // operation somehow.
5899 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005900
5901 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
5902 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
5903
5904 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
5905 QualType ConvType
5906 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5907 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
5908 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
5909 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5910 ArgIdx--;
5911 } else if (Cand->Function) {
5912 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5913 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
5914 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
5915 ArgIdx--;
5916 } else {
5917 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
5918 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
5919 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
5920 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005921 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
5922 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
5923 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005924 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005925 return;
5926 }
5927
5928 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
5929 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5930 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
5931 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
5932 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005933 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
5934 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005935 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005936 else
5937 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
5938 }
5939}
5940
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005941} // end anonymous namespace
5942
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005943/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
5944/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005945/// set.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005946void
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005947Sema::PrintOverloadCandidates(OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005948 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00005949 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahaniane7196432009-10-12 20:11:40 +00005950 const char *Opc,
Fariborz Jahanian29f9d392009-10-09 00:13:15 +00005951 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005952 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
5953 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
5954 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
5955 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(CandidateSet.size());
5956 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
5957 LastCand = CandidateSet.end();
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005958 Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
5959 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005960 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005961 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
5962 CompleteNonViableCandidate(*this, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00005963 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
5964 Cands.push_back(Cand);
5965 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
5966 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005967 }
5968 }
5969
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00005970 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
5971 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(*this));
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005972
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005973 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005974
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005975 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00005976 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = Diags.getShowOverloads();
5977 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00005978 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
5979 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00005980
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00005981 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
5982 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
5983 // candidate list.
5984 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
5985 break;
5986 }
5987 ++CandsShown;
5988
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005989 if (Cand->Function)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00005990 NoteFunctionCandidate(*this, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00005991 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
5992 NoteSurrogateCandidate(*this, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00005993 else {
5994 assert(Cand->Viable &&
5995 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005996 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
5997 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
5998 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
5999 //
6000 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
6001 // different ambiguities, though.
6002 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
6003 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(*this, OpLoc, Cand);
6004 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
6005 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006006
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006007 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006008 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(*this, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006009 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006010 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00006011
6012 if (I != E)
Jeffrey Yasskin5d474d02010-06-11 06:58:43 +00006013 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006014}
6015
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006016static bool CheckUnresolvedAccess(Sema &S, OverloadExpr *E, DeclAccessPair D) {
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006017 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E))
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006018 return S.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006019
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006020 return S.CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E), D);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006021}
6022
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006023/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
6024/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
6025/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
6026/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
6027///
6028/// @code
6029/// int f(double);
6030/// int f(int);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006031///
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006032/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
6033/// @endcode
6034///
6035/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
6036/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
6037/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
6038FunctionDecl *
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006039Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006040 bool Complain,
6041 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006042 QualType FunctionType = ToType;
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006043 bool IsMember = false;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006044 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006045 FunctionType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006046 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Daniel Dunbarb566c6c2009-02-26 19:13:44 +00006047 FunctionType = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006048 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006049 ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006050 FunctionType = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6051 IsMember = true;
6052 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006053
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006054 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6055 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6056 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006057 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6058 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6059 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006060 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).getPointer();
6061 TemplateArgumentListInfo ETABuffer, *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
6062 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
6063 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ETABuffer);
6064 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &ETABuffer;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006065 }
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006066
6067 // We expect a pointer or reference to function, or a function pointer.
6068 FunctionType = Context.getCanonicalType(FunctionType).getUnqualifiedType();
6069 if (!FunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
6070 if (Complain)
6071 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
6072 << OvlExpr->getName() << ToType;
6073
6074 return 0;
6075 }
6076
6077 assert(From->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006078
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006079 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6080 // whose type matches exactly.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006081 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Douglas Gregorb242683d2010-04-01 18:32:35 +00006082 llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> NonMatches;
6083
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006084 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction = false;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006085 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6086 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006087 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
6088 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6089
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006090 // C++ [over.over]p3:
6091 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
Sebastian Redl16d307d2009-02-05 12:33:33 +00006092 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
6093 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006094 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
6095 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006096
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006097 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006098 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006099 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006100 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006101 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006102 // static when converting to member pointer.
6103 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
6104 continue;
6105 } else if (IsMember)
6106 continue;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006107
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006108 // C++ [over.over]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006109 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
6110 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
6111 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
6112 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006113 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor3a923c2d2009-09-24 23:14:47 +00006114 // FIXME: We don't really want to build the specialization here, do we?
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006115 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006116 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006117 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006118 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006119 FunctionType, Specialization, Info)) {
6120 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
6121 (void)Result;
6122 } else {
Douglas Gregor3a923c2d2009-09-24 23:14:47 +00006123 // FIXME: If the match isn't exact, shouldn't we just drop this as
6124 // a candidate? Find a testcase before changing the code.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006125 assert(FunctionType
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006126 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006127 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(),
6128 cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006129 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006130
6131 continue;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00006132 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006133
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006134 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006135 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
6136 // when converting to member pointer.
6137 if (Method->isStatic() == IsMember)
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006138 continue;
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006139
6140 // If we have explicit template arguments, skip non-templates.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006141 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00006142 continue;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006143 } else if (IsMember)
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006144 continue;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006145
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00006146 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00006147 QualType ResultTy;
6148 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FunctionType, FunDecl->getType()) ||
6149 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), FunctionType,
6150 ResultTy)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006151 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(I.getPair(),
6152 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006153 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
6154 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006155 }
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006156 }
6157
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006158 // If there were 0 or 1 matches, we're done.
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006159 if (Matches.empty()) {
6160 if (Complain) {
6161 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
6162 << OvlExpr->getName() << FunctionType;
6163 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6164 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6165 I != E; ++I)
6166 if (FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
6167 NoteOverloadCandidate(F);
6168 }
6169
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006170 return 0;
Douglas Gregor064fdb22010-04-14 23:11:21 +00006171 } else if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006172 FunctionDecl *Result = Matches[0].second;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006173 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006174 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Result);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006175 if (Complain)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006176 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006177 return Result;
6178 }
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006179
6180 // C++ [over.over]p4:
6181 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006182 if (!FoundNonTemplateFunction) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006183 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
6184 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
6185 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
6186 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
6187 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
6188
6189 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
6190 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
6191 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
6192 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006193
6194 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
6195 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6196 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006197
6198 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006199 getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006200 TPOC_Other, From->getLocStart(),
6201 PDiag(),
6202 PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006203 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006204 PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6205 << (unsigned) oc_function_template);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006206 assert(Result != MatchesCopy.end() && "no most-specialized template");
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006207 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), *Result);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006208 FoundResult = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006209 if (Complain) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006210 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, FoundResult);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006211 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundResult, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
6212 }
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006213 return cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006214 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006215
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006216 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
6217 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006218 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006219 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006220 ++I;
6221 else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006222 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
6223 Matches.set_size(N);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006224 }
6225 }
Douglas Gregorfae1d712009-09-26 03:56:17 +00006226
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006227 // [...] After such eliminations, if any, there shall remain exactly one
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006228 // selected function.
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006229 if (Matches.size() == 1) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006230 MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Matches[0].second);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006231 FoundResult = Matches[0].first;
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006232 if (Complain) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006233 CheckUnresolvedAccess(*this, OvlExpr, Matches[0].first);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006234 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Matches[0].first, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
6235 }
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006236 return cast<FunctionDecl>(Matches[0].second);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00006237 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006238
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00006239 // FIXME: We should probably return the same thing that BestViableFunction
6240 // returns (even if we issue the diagnostics here).
6241 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006242 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName();
6243 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
6244 NoteOverloadCandidate(Matches[I].second);
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006245 return 0;
6246}
6247
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006248/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
6249/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
6250///
6251/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
6252/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
6253/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
6254/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
6255FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From) {
6256 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6257 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
6258 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006259 // C++ [over.over]p1:
6260 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
6261 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006262
6263 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy)
6264 return 0;
6265
6266 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).getPointer();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006267
6268 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006269 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006270 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006271
6272 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
6273 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006274
6275 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
6276 // whose type matches exactly.
6277 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006278 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6279 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006280 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
6281 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
6282 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
6283 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
6284 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
6285 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
6286 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I);
6287
6288 // C++ [over.over]p2:
6289 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
6290 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
6291 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
6292 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
6293 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006294 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006295 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00006296 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6297 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6298 Specialization, Info)) {
6299 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
6300 (void)Result;
6301 continue;
6302 }
6303
6304 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
6305 if (Matched)
6306 return 0;
6307
6308 Matched = Specialization;
6309 }
6310
6311 return Matched;
6312}
6313
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006314/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
6315static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006316 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006317 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006318 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6319 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6320 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006321 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006322 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
6323 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
6324
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006325 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006326 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006327 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006328 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006329 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006330 }
6331
6332 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
6333 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006334 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
6335 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006336 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006337 return;
6338 }
6339
6340 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
6341
6342 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006343}
6344
6345/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
6346/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006347void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006348 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6349 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6350 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006351
6352#ifndef NDEBUG
6353 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
6354 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006355 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006356 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
6357 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
6358 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
6359 //
6360 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
6361 //
6362 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006363 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006364 //
6365 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
6366 // template
6367 //
6368 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006369
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006370 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
6371 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
6372 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6373 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
6374 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
6375 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
6376 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006377 }
6378 }
6379#endif
6380
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006381 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
6382 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
6383 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
6384 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
6385 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
6386 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
6387 }
6388
6389 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
6390 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006391 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006392 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006393 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006394
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006395 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006396 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
6397 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006398 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006399 CandidateSet,
6400 PartialOverloading);
6401}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006402
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006403static Sema::OwningExprResult Destroy(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *Fn,
6404 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6405 Fn->Destroy(SemaRef.Context);
6406 for (unsigned Arg = 0; Arg < NumArgs; ++Arg)
6407 Args[Arg]->Destroy(SemaRef.Context);
6408 return SemaRef.ExprError();
6409}
6410
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006411/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
6412///
6413/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006414static Sema::OwningExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00006415BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006416 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
6417 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
6418 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6419 SourceLocation *CommaLocs,
6420 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006421
6422 CXXScopeSpec SS;
6423 if (ULE->getQualifier()) {
6424 SS.setScopeRep(ULE->getQualifier());
6425 SS.setRange(ULE->getQualifierRange());
6426 }
6427
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006428 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
6429 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
6430 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
6431 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
6432 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
6433 }
6434
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006435 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
6436 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00006437 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006438 return Destroy(SemaRef, Fn, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006439
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006440 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
6441
6442 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
6443 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
6444 Sema::OwningExprResult NewFn = SemaRef.ExprError();
6445 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
6446 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
6447 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
6448 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
6449 else
6450 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
6451
6452 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
6453 return Destroy(SemaRef, Fn, Args, NumArgs);
6454
6455 Fn->Destroy(SemaRef.Context);
6456
6457 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
6458 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
6459 // end up here.
6460 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, move(NewFn), LParenLoc,
6461 Sema::MultiExprArg(SemaRef, (void**) Args, NumArgs),
6462 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006463}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00006464
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006465/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006466/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
6467/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
6468/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
6469/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00006470/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006471/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006472Sema::OwningExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00006473Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006474 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
6475 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6476 SourceLocation *CommaLocs,
6477 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
6478#ifndef NDEBUG
6479 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
6480 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
6481 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
6482
6483 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
6484 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
6485 FunctionDecl *F;
6486 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
6487 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
6488 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
6489 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
6490
6491 // We don't perform ADL in C.
6492 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
6493 }
6494#endif
6495
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006496 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00006497
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006498 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
6499 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
6500 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006501
6502 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
6503 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
6504 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006505 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00006506 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006507 CommaLocs, RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00006508
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006509 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006510 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006511 case OR_Success: {
6512 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006513 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006514 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006515 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006516 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
6517 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006518
6519 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00006520 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006521 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006522 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006523 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006524 break;
6525
6526 case OR_Ambiguous:
6527 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006528 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006529 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006530 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006531
6532 case OR_Deleted:
6533 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
6534 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006535 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006536 << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006537 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006538 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006539 }
6540
6541 // Overload resolution failed. Destroy all of the subexpressions and
6542 // return NULL.
6543 Fn->Destroy(Context);
6544 for (unsigned Arg = 0; Arg < NumArgs; ++Arg)
6545 Args[Arg]->Destroy(Context);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00006546 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00006547}
6548
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006549static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00006550 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
6551 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
6552}
6553
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006554/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
6555/// operator.
6556///
6557/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
6558///
6559/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
6560/// operator.
6561///
6562/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
6563/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
6564/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
6565/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
6566/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
6567/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
6568///
6569/// \param input The input argument.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006570Sema::OwningExprResult
6571Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
6572 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6573 ExprArg input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006574 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
6575 Expr *Input = (Expr *)input.get();
6576
6577 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
6578 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
6579 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6580
6581 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
6582 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006583
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006584 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
6585 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
6586 // post-decrement.
6587 if (Opc == UnaryOperator::PostInc || Opc == UnaryOperator::PostDec) {
6588 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006589 Args[1] = new (Context) IntegerLiteral(Zero, Context.IntTy,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006590 SourceLocation());
6591 NumArgs = 2;
6592 }
6593
6594 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00006595 if (Fns.empty())
6596 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(input.takeAs<Expr>(),
6597 Opc,
6598 Context.DependentTy,
6599 OpLoc));
6600
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006601 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006602 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006603 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00006604 0, SourceRange(), OpName, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00006605 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
6606 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006607 input.release();
6608 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
6609 &Args[0], NumArgs,
6610 Context.DependentTy,
6611 OpLoc));
6612 }
6613
6614 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006615 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006616
6617 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006618 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006619
6620 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
6621 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
6622
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006623 // Add candidates from ADL.
6624 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00006625 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006626 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
6627 CandidateSet);
6628
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006629 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006630 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006631
6632 // Perform overload resolution.
6633 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006634 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006635 case OR_Success: {
6636 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
6637 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006638
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006639 if (FnDecl) {
6640 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
6641 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006642
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006643 // Convert the arguments.
6644 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006645 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00006646
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006647 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
6648 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006649 return ExprError();
6650 } else {
6651 // Convert the arguments.
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00006652 OwningExprResult InputInit
6653 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00006654 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00006655 SourceLocation(),
6656 move(input));
6657 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006658 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00006659
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00006660 input = move(InputInit);
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00006661 Input = (Expr *)input.get();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006662 }
6663
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006664 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
6665
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006666 // Determine the result type
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00006667 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006668
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006669 // Build the actual expression node.
6670 Expr *FnExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(FnDecl, FnDecl->getType(),
6671 SourceLocation());
6672 UsualUnaryConversions(FnExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006673
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006674 input.release();
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00006675 Args[0] = Input;
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00006676 ExprOwningPtr<CallExpr> TheCall(this,
6677 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00006678 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, OpLoc));
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006679
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00006680 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall.get(),
6681 FnDecl))
6682 return ExprError();
6683
6684 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006685 } else {
6686 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
6687 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
6688 // operator node.
6689 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006690 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006691 return ExprError();
6692
6693 break;
6694 }
6695 }
6696
6697 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
6698 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
6699 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
6700 break;
6701
6702 case OR_Ambiguous:
6703 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper)
6704 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
6705 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006706 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahaniane7196432009-10-12 20:11:40 +00006707 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006708 return ExprError();
6709
6710 case OR_Deleted:
6711 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
6712 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
6713 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
6714 << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006715 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006716 return ExprError();
6717 }
6718
6719 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
6720 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
6721 // build a built-in operation.
6722 input.release();
6723 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Owned(Input));
6724}
6725
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006726/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
6727/// operator.
6728///
6729/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
6730///
6731/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
6732/// operator.
6733///
6734/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
6735/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
6736/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
6737/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
6738/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
6739/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
6740///
6741/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
6742/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006743Sema::OwningExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006744Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006745 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006746 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006747 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006748 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006749 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006750
6751 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
6752 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
6753 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6754
6755 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
6756 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006757 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006758 if (Fns.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006759 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
6760 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
6761 if (Opc <= BinaryOperator::Assign || Opc > BinaryOperator::OrAssign)
6762 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
6763 Context.DependentTy, OpLoc));
6764
6765 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
6766 Context.DependentTy,
6767 Context.DependentTy,
6768 Context.DependentTy,
6769 OpLoc));
6770 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006771
6772 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006773 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006775 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00006776 0, SourceRange(), OpName, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00006777 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
6778 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006779 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006780 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006781 Context.DependentTy,
6782 OpLoc));
6783 }
6784
6785 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
6786 // create a built-in binary operator.
6787 if (Opc == BinaryOperator::PtrMemD)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006788 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006789
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00006790 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
6791 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
6792 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
6793 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
6794 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
6795 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
6796 if (Opc==BinaryOperator::Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006797 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006798
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006799 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006800 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006801
6802 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006803 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006804
6805 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
6806 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6807
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006808 // Add candidates from ADL.
6809 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
6810 Args, 2,
6811 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
6812 CandidateSet);
6813
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006814 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006815 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006816
6817 // Perform overload resolution.
6818 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006819 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006820 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006821 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
6822 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
6823
6824 if (FnDecl) {
6825 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
6826 // operator.
6827
6828 // Convert the arguments.
6829 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00006830 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006831 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00006832
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00006833 OwningExprResult Arg1
6834 = PerformCopyInitialization(
6835 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6836 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
6837 SourceLocation(),
6838 Owned(Args[1]));
6839 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006840 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00006841
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00006842 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00006843 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00006844 return ExprError();
6845
6846 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006847 } else {
6848 // Convert the arguments.
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00006849 OwningExprResult Arg0
6850 = PerformCopyInitialization(
6851 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6852 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
6853 SourceLocation(),
6854 Owned(Args[0]));
6855 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006856 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00006857
6858 OwningExprResult Arg1
6859 = PerformCopyInitialization(
6860 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6861 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
6862 SourceLocation(),
6863 Owned(Args[1]));
6864 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
6865 return ExprError();
6866 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
6867 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006868 }
6869
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00006870 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
6871
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006872 // Determine the result type
6873 QualType ResultTy
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006874 = FnDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006875 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonReferenceType();
6876
6877 // Build the actual expression node.
6878 Expr *FnExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(FnDecl, FnDecl->getType(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidisef1c1e52009-07-14 03:19:38 +00006879 OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006880 UsualUnaryConversions(FnExpr);
6881
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00006882 ExprOwningPtr<CXXOperatorCallExpr>
6883 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr,
6884 Args, 2, ResultTy,
6885 OpLoc));
6886
6887 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall.get(),
6888 FnDecl))
6889 return ExprError();
6890
6891 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006892 } else {
6893 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
6894 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
6895 // operator node.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006896 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006897 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006898 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006899 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006900 return ExprError();
6901
6902 break;
6903 }
6904 }
6905
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006906 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
6907 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
6908 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
6909 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
6910 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
6911 if (Opc == BinaryOperator::Comma)
6912 break;
6913
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00006914 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment operator
6915 // do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that no overloaded
6916 // assignment operator found
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006917 OwningExprResult Result = ExprError();
6918 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
6919 Opc >= BinaryOperator::Assign && Opc <= BinaryOperator::OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00006920 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
6921 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006922 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006923 } else {
6924 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
6925 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
6926 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00006927 }
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006928 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
6929 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
6930 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006931 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
Fariborz Jahaniane7196432009-10-12 20:11:40 +00006932 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006933 return move(Result);
6934 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006935
6936 case OR_Ambiguous:
6937 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper)
6938 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006939 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006940 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
Fariborz Jahaniane7196432009-10-12 20:11:40 +00006941 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006942 return ExprError();
6943
6944 case OR_Deleted:
6945 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
6946 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
6947 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006948 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00006949 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006950 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006951 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006952
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00006953 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00006954 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006955}
6956
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00006957Action::OwningExprResult
6958Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
6959 SourceLocation RLoc,
6960 ExprArg Base, ExprArg Idx) {
6961 Expr *Args[2] = { static_cast<Expr*>(Base.get()),
6962 static_cast<Expr*>(Idx.get()) };
6963 DeclarationName OpName =
6964 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
6965
6966 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
6967 // expression.
6968 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
6969
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006970 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006971 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00006972 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*Dependent*/ true, NamingClass,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00006973 0, SourceRange(), OpName, LLoc,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00006974 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
6975 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
6976 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00006977 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00006978
6979 Base.release();
6980 Idx.release();
6981 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
6982 Args, 2,
6983 Context.DependentTy,
6984 RLoc));
6985 }
6986
6987 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00006988 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00006989
6990 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
6991
6992 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
6993 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6994
6995 // Add builtin operator candidates.
6996 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6997
6998 // Perform overload resolution.
6999 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
7000 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, LLoc, Best)) {
7001 case OR_Success: {
7002 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7003 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
7004
7005 if (FnDecl) {
7006 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7007 // operator.
7008
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007009 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007010 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007011
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007012 // Convert the arguments.
7013 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007014 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007015 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007016 return ExprError();
7017
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00007018 // Convert the arguments.
7019 OwningExprResult InputInit
7020 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
7021 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
7022 SourceLocation(),
7023 Owned(Args[1]));
7024 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
7025 return ExprError();
7026
7027 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
7028
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007029 // Determine the result type
7030 QualType ResultTy
7031 = FnDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType();
7032 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonReferenceType();
7033
7034 // Build the actual expression node.
7035 Expr *FnExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(FnDecl, FnDecl->getType(),
7036 LLoc);
7037 UsualUnaryConversions(FnExpr);
7038
7039 Base.release();
7040 Idx.release();
7041 ExprOwningPtr<CXXOperatorCallExpr>
7042 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
7043 FnExpr, Args, 2,
7044 ResultTy, RLoc));
7045
7046 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall.get(),
7047 FnDecl))
7048 return ExprError();
7049
7050 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release());
7051 } else {
7052 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7053 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7054 // operator node.
7055 if (PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007056 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing) ||
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007057 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00007058 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing))
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007059 return ExprError();
7060
7061 break;
7062 }
7063 }
7064
7065 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007066 if (CandidateSet.empty())
7067 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
7068 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
7069 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
7070 else
7071 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
7072 << Args[0]->getType()
7073 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007074 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007075 "[]", LLoc);
7076 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007077 }
7078
7079 case OR_Ambiguous:
7080 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper)
7081 << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007082 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007083 "[]", LLoc);
7084 return ExprError();
7085
7086 case OR_Deleted:
7087 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7088 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
7089 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007090 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007091 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00007092 return ExprError();
7093 }
7094
7095 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
7096 Base.release();
7097 Idx.release();
7098 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Owned(Args[0]), LLoc,
7099 Owned(Args[1]), RLoc);
7100}
7101
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007102/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
7103/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
7104/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
7105/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
7106/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
7107/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member
7108/// function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007109Sema::OwningExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007110Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
7111 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007112 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation *CommaLocs,
7113 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
7114 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
7115 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007116 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
7117
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007118 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007119 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00007120 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007121 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007122 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
7123 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007124 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007125 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007126 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007127 } else {
7128 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007129 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
7130
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007131 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007132
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007133 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007134 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007135
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007136 // FIXME: avoid copy.
7137 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
7138 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7139 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
7140 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
7141 }
7142
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007143 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
7144 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7145
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007146 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
7147 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
7148 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
7149 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
7150
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007151 if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007152 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
7153 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007154 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00007155 continue;
7156
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007157 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00007158 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007159 CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007160 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007161 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007162 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007163 ObjectType, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007164 CandidateSet,
7165 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007166 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00007167 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007168
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007169 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
7170
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007171 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007172 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, UnresExpr->getLocStart(), Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007173 case OR_Success:
7174 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007175 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007176 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007177 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007178 break;
7179
7180 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007181 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007182 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007183 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007184 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007185 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007186 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007187
7188 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007189 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007190 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007191 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007192 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007193 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007194
7195 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007196 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007197 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00007198 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007199 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007200 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007201 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007202 }
7203
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007204 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007205
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007206 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
7207 // non-member call based on that function.
7208 if (Method->isStatic()) {
7209 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
7210 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
7211 }
7212
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007213 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007214 }
7215
7216 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007217 ExprOwningPtr<CXXMemberCallExpr>
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007218 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007219 NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007220 Method->getResultType().getNonReferenceType(),
7221 RParenLoc));
7222
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007223 // Check for a valid return type.
7224 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
7225 TheCall.get(), Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007226 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00007227
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007228 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007229 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
7230 // it was done at lookup.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007231 Expr *ObjectArg = MemExpr->getBase();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007232 if (!Method->isStatic() &&
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007233 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(ObjectArg, Qualifier,
7234 FoundDecl, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007235 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007236 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg);
7237
7238 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00007239 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007240 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(&*TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007241 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007242 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007243
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00007244 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall.get()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007245 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00007246
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007247 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00007248}
7249
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007250/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
7251/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
7252/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
7253/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007254Sema::ExprResult
7255Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Object,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00007256 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007257 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007258 SourceLocation *CommaLocs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007259 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
7260 assert(Object->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007261 const RecordType *Record = Object->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007262
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007263 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
7264 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00007265 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007266 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
7267 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
7268 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
7269 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007270 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00007271 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007272
7273 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007274 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007275 << Object->getSourceRange()))
7276 return true;
7277
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007278 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7279 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
7280 R.suppressDiagnostics();
7281
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00007282 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00007283 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007284 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object->getType(),
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00007285 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00007286 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00007287 }
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007288
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007289 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
7290 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
7291 // form
7292 //
7293 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
7294 //
7295 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
7296 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00007297 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
7298 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
7299 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
7300 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007301 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
7302 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
7303 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
7304 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
7305 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007306 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00007307 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00007308 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007309 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007310 NamedDecl *D = *I;
7311 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
7312 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7313 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7314
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007315 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
7316 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007317 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007318 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007319
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007320 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007321
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007322 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
7323 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
7324 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7325 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7326 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007327
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00007328 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007329 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007330 Object->getType(), Args, NumArgs,
7331 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007332 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007333
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007334 // Perform overload resolution.
7335 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007336 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, Object->getLocStart(), Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007337 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007338 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
7339 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007340 break;
7341
7342 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00007343 if (CandidateSet.empty())
7344 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
7345 << Object->getType() << /*call*/ 1
7346 << Object->getSourceRange();
7347 else
7348 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7349 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
7350 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007351 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007352 break;
7353
7354 case OR_Ambiguous:
7355 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7356 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007357 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007358 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007359 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007360
7361 case OR_Deleted:
7362 Diag(Object->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7363 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
7364 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7365 << Object->getType() << Object->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007366 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007367 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007368 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007369
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007370 if (Best == CandidateSet.end()) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007371 // We had an error; delete all of the subexpressions and return
7372 // the error.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007373 Object->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007374 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007375 Args[ArgIdx]->Destroy(Context);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007376 return true;
7377 }
7378
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007379 if (Best->Function == 0) {
7380 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
7381 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007382 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007383 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
7384 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
7385
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007386 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007387 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00007388
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007389 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
7390 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
7391 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00007392
7393 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00007394 // and then call it.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007395 CXXMemberCallExpr *CE = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object, Best->FoundDecl,
7396 Conv);
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00007397
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00007398 return ActOnCallExpr(S, ExprArg(*this, CE), LParenLoc,
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007399 MultiExprArg(*this, (ExprTy**)Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregore5e775b2010-04-13 15:50:39 +00007400 CommaLocs, RParenLoc).result();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007401 }
7402
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007403 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007404 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00007405
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00007406 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
7407 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
7408 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
7409 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007410 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007411
7412 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7413 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
7414
7415 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
7416 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
7417 // list).
7418 Expr **MethodArgs;
7419 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
7420 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
7421 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
7422 } else {
7423 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
7424 }
7425 MethodArgs[0] = Object;
7426 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
7427 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007428
7429 Expr *NewFn = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(Method, Method->getType(),
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007430 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007431 UsualUnaryConversions(NewFn);
7432
7433 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
7434 // owned.
7435 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007436 ExprOwningPtr<CXXOperatorCallExpr>
7437 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007438 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007439 ResultTy, RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007440 delete [] MethodArgs;
7441
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00007442 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall.get(),
7443 Method))
7444 return true;
7445
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007446 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
7447 // slots in the call for them.
7448 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007449 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007450 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
7451 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
7452
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00007453 bool IsError = false;
7454
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007455 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00007456 IsError |= PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object, /*Qualifier=*/0,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007457 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007458 TheCall->setArg(0, Object);
7459
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00007460
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007461 // Check the argument types.
7462 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007463 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007464 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007465 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007466
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007467 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00007468
7469 OwningExprResult InputInit
7470 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
7471 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
7472 SourceLocation(), Owned(Arg));
7473
7474 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
7475 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007476 } else {
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00007477 OwningExprResult DefArg
7478 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
7479 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
7480 IsError = true;
7481 break;
7482 }
7483
7484 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00007485 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007486
7487 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
7488 }
7489
7490 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
7491 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
7492 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
7493 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
7494 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00007495 IsError |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, VariadicMethod, 0);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007496 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
7497 }
7498 }
7499
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00007500 if (IsError) return true;
7501
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00007502 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall.get()))
7503 return true;
7504
Douglas Gregore5e775b2010-04-13 15:50:39 +00007505 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall.release()).result();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00007506}
7507
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007508/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007509/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007510/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007511Sema::OwningExprResult
7512Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, ExprArg BaseIn, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
7513 Expr *Base = static_cast<Expr *>(BaseIn.get());
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007514 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() && "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007515
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007516 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
7517
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007518 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
7519 //
7520 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
7521 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
7522 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
7523 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007524 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007525 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007526 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007527
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007528 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00007529 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
7530 << Base->getSourceRange()))
7531 return ExprError();
7532
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00007533 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7534 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
7535 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00007536
7537 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007538 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007539 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), 0, 0, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007540 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00007541 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007542
7543 // Perform overload resolution.
7544 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007545 switch (BestViableFunction(CandidateSet, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007546 case OR_Success:
7547 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
7548 break;
7549
7550 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
7551 if (CandidateSet.empty())
7552 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007553 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007554 else
7555 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007556 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007557 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007558 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007559
7560 case OR_Ambiguous:
7561 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper)
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00007562 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007563 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007564 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007565
7566 case OR_Deleted:
7567 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
7568 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00007569 << "->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCallad907772010-01-12 07:18:19 +00007570 PrintOverloadCandidates(CandidateSet, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007571 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007572 }
7573
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007574 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007575 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007576
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007577 // Convert the object parameter.
7578 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007579 if (PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7580 Best->FoundDecl, Method))
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007581 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00007582
7583 // No concerns about early exits now.
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00007584 BaseIn.release();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007585
7586 // Build the operator call.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00007587 Expr *FnExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(Method, Method->getType(),
7588 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007589 UsualUnaryConversions(FnExpr);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00007590
7591 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType().getNonReferenceType();
7592 ExprOwningPtr<CXXOperatorCallExpr>
7593 TheCall(this, new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr,
7594 &Base, 1, ResultTy, OpLoc));
7595
7596 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall.get(),
7597 Method))
7598 return ExprError();
7599 return move(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00007600}
7601
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007602/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
7603/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
7604/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
7605/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00007606/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00007607Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007608 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007609 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007610 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
7611 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007612 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
7613 return PE->Retain();
7614
7615 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
7616 }
7617
7618 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007619 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
7620 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00007621 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007622 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00007623 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007624 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
7625 return ICE->Retain();
7626
7627 return new (Context) ImplicitCastExpr(ICE->getType(),
7628 ICE->getCastKind(),
Anders Carlsson0c509ee2010-04-24 16:57:13 +00007629 SubExpr, CXXBaseSpecifierArray(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007630 ICE->isLvalueCast());
7631 }
7632
7633 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007634 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UnaryOperator::AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007635 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00007636 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7637 if (Method->isStatic()) {
7638 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
7639 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007640 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00007641 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
7642 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
7643 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007644 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
7645 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007646 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
7647 return UnOp->Retain();
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007648
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007649 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
7650 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
7651 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
7652 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
7653
7654 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
7655 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
7656 // appropriate pointer to member type.
7657 QualType ClassType
7658 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
7659 QualType MemPtrType
7660 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
7661
7662 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UnaryOperator::AddrOf,
7663 MemPtrType, UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00007664 }
7665 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007666 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
7667 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007668 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
7669 return UnOp->Retain();
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00007670
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007671 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UnaryOperator::AddrOf,
7672 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
7673 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007674 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007675
7676 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007677 // FIXME: avoid copy.
7678 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00007679 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007680 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
7681 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00007682 }
7683
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007684 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
7685 ULE->getQualifier(),
7686 ULE->getQualifierRange(),
7687 Fn,
7688 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007689 Fn->getType(),
7690 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007691 }
7692
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00007693 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007694 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007695 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
7696 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7697 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
7698 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
7699 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007700
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007701 Expr *Base;
7702
7703 // If we're filling in
7704 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
7705 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
7706 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
7707 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
7708 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
7709 Fn,
7710 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
7711 Fn->getType(),
7712 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00007713 } else {
7714 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
7715 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
7716 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierRange().getBegin();
7717 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
7718 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
7719 /*isImplicit=*/true);
7720 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007721 } else
7722 Base = MemExpr->getBase()->Retain();
7723
7724 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007725 MemExpr->isArrow(),
7726 MemExpr->getQualifier(),
7727 MemExpr->getQualifierRange(),
7728 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007729 Found,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007730 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00007731 TemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007732 Fn->getType());
7733 }
7734
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00007735 assert(false && "Invalid reference to overloaded function");
7736 return E->Retain();
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007737}
7738
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00007739Sema::OwningExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(OwningExprResult E,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00007740 DeclAccessPair Found,
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00007741 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007742 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00007743}
7744
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007745} // end namespace clang